526195ad0d
Submitted-By: Kent Vander Velden <graphix@iastate.edu>
8660 lines
262 KiB
C
8660 lines
262 KiB
C
/* Common subexpression elimination for GNU compiler.
|
||
Copyright (C) 1987, 88, 89, 92, 93, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||
|
||
This file is part of GNU CC.
|
||
|
||
GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||
any later version.
|
||
|
||
GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||
|
||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||
along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
|
||
the Free Software Foundation, 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA. */
|
||
|
||
|
||
#include "config.h"
|
||
/* Must precede rtl.h for FFS. */
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <string.h>
|
||
|
||
#include "rtl.h"
|
||
#include "regs.h"
|
||
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
|
||
#include "flags.h"
|
||
#include "real.h"
|
||
#include "insn-config.h"
|
||
#include "recog.h"
|
||
|
||
#include <setjmp.h>
|
||
|
||
/* The basic idea of common subexpression elimination is to go
|
||
through the code, keeping a record of expressions that would
|
||
have the same value at the current scan point, and replacing
|
||
expressions encountered with the cheapest equivalent expression.
|
||
|
||
It is too complicated to keep track of the different possibilities
|
||
when control paths merge; so, at each label, we forget all that is
|
||
known and start fresh. This can be described as processing each
|
||
basic block separately. Note, however, that these are not quite
|
||
the same as the basic blocks found by a later pass and used for
|
||
data flow analysis and register packing. We do not need to start fresh
|
||
after a conditional jump instruction if there is no label there.
|
||
|
||
We use two data structures to record the equivalent expressions:
|
||
a hash table for most expressions, and several vectors together
|
||
with "quantity numbers" to record equivalent (pseudo) registers.
|
||
|
||
The use of the special data structure for registers is desirable
|
||
because it is faster. It is possible because registers references
|
||
contain a fairly small number, the register number, taken from
|
||
a contiguously allocated series, and two register references are
|
||
identical if they have the same number. General expressions
|
||
do not have any such thing, so the only way to retrieve the
|
||
information recorded on an expression other than a register
|
||
is to keep it in a hash table.
|
||
|
||
Registers and "quantity numbers":
|
||
|
||
At the start of each basic block, all of the (hardware and pseudo)
|
||
registers used in the function are given distinct quantity
|
||
numbers to indicate their contents. During scan, when the code
|
||
copies one register into another, we copy the quantity number.
|
||
When a register is loaded in any other way, we allocate a new
|
||
quantity number to describe the value generated by this operation.
|
||
`reg_qty' records what quantity a register is currently thought
|
||
of as containing.
|
||
|
||
All real quantity numbers are greater than or equal to `max_reg'.
|
||
If register N has not been assigned a quantity, reg_qty[N] will equal N.
|
||
|
||
Quantity numbers below `max_reg' do not exist and none of the `qty_...'
|
||
variables should be referenced with an index below `max_reg'.
|
||
|
||
We also maintain a bidirectional chain of registers for each
|
||
quantity number. `qty_first_reg', `qty_last_reg',
|
||
`reg_next_eqv' and `reg_prev_eqv' hold these chains.
|
||
|
||
The first register in a chain is the one whose lifespan is least local.
|
||
Among equals, it is the one that was seen first.
|
||
We replace any equivalent register with that one.
|
||
|
||
If two registers have the same quantity number, it must be true that
|
||
REG expressions with `qty_mode' must be in the hash table for both
|
||
registers and must be in the same class.
|
||
|
||
The converse is not true. Since hard registers may be referenced in
|
||
any mode, two REG expressions might be equivalent in the hash table
|
||
but not have the same quantity number if the quantity number of one
|
||
of the registers is not the same mode as those expressions.
|
||
|
||
Constants and quantity numbers
|
||
|
||
When a quantity has a known constant value, that value is stored
|
||
in the appropriate element of qty_const. This is in addition to
|
||
putting the constant in the hash table as is usual for non-regs.
|
||
|
||
Whether a reg or a constant is preferred is determined by the configuration
|
||
macro CONST_COSTS and will often depend on the constant value. In any
|
||
event, expressions containing constants can be simplified, by fold_rtx.
|
||
|
||
When a quantity has a known nearly constant value (such as an address
|
||
of a stack slot), that value is stored in the appropriate element
|
||
of qty_const.
|
||
|
||
Integer constants don't have a machine mode. However, cse
|
||
determines the intended machine mode from the destination
|
||
of the instruction that moves the constant. The machine mode
|
||
is recorded in the hash table along with the actual RTL
|
||
constant expression so that different modes are kept separate.
|
||
|
||
Other expressions:
|
||
|
||
To record known equivalences among expressions in general
|
||
we use a hash table called `table'. It has a fixed number of buckets
|
||
that contain chains of `struct table_elt' elements for expressions.
|
||
These chains connect the elements whose expressions have the same
|
||
hash codes.
|
||
|
||
Other chains through the same elements connect the elements which
|
||
currently have equivalent values.
|
||
|
||
Register references in an expression are canonicalized before hashing
|
||
the expression. This is done using `reg_qty' and `qty_first_reg'.
|
||
The hash code of a register reference is computed using the quantity
|
||
number, not the register number.
|
||
|
||
When the value of an expression changes, it is necessary to remove from the
|
||
hash table not just that expression but all expressions whose values
|
||
could be different as a result.
|
||
|
||
1. If the value changing is in memory, except in special cases
|
||
ANYTHING referring to memory could be changed. That is because
|
||
nobody knows where a pointer does not point.
|
||
The function `invalidate_memory' removes what is necessary.
|
||
|
||
The special cases are when the address is constant or is
|
||
a constant plus a fixed register such as the frame pointer
|
||
or a static chain pointer. When such addresses are stored in,
|
||
we can tell exactly which other such addresses must be invalidated
|
||
due to overlap. `invalidate' does this.
|
||
All expressions that refer to non-constant
|
||
memory addresses are also invalidated. `invalidate_memory' does this.
|
||
|
||
2. If the value changing is a register, all expressions
|
||
containing references to that register, and only those,
|
||
must be removed.
|
||
|
||
Because searching the entire hash table for expressions that contain
|
||
a register is very slow, we try to figure out when it isn't necessary.
|
||
Precisely, this is necessary only when expressions have been
|
||
entered in the hash table using this register, and then the value has
|
||
changed, and then another expression wants to be added to refer to
|
||
the register's new value. This sequence of circumstances is rare
|
||
within any one basic block.
|
||
|
||
The vectors `reg_tick' and `reg_in_table' are used to detect this case.
|
||
reg_tick[i] is incremented whenever a value is stored in register i.
|
||
reg_in_table[i] holds -1 if no references to register i have been
|
||
entered in the table; otherwise, it contains the value reg_tick[i] had
|
||
when the references were entered. If we want to enter a reference
|
||
and reg_in_table[i] != reg_tick[i], we must scan and remove old references.
|
||
Until we want to enter a new entry, the mere fact that the two vectors
|
||
don't match makes the entries be ignored if anyone tries to match them.
|
||
|
||
Registers themselves are entered in the hash table as well as in
|
||
the equivalent-register chains. However, the vectors `reg_tick'
|
||
and `reg_in_table' do not apply to expressions which are simple
|
||
register references. These expressions are removed from the table
|
||
immediately when they become invalid, and this can be done even if
|
||
we do not immediately search for all the expressions that refer to
|
||
the register.
|
||
|
||
A CLOBBER rtx in an instruction invalidates its operand for further
|
||
reuse. A CLOBBER or SET rtx whose operand is a MEM:BLK
|
||
invalidates everything that resides in memory.
|
||
|
||
Related expressions:
|
||
|
||
Constant expressions that differ only by an additive integer
|
||
are called related. When a constant expression is put in
|
||
the table, the related expression with no constant term
|
||
is also entered. These are made to point at each other
|
||
so that it is possible to find out if there exists any
|
||
register equivalent to an expression related to a given expression. */
|
||
|
||
/* One plus largest register number used in this function. */
|
||
|
||
static int max_reg;
|
||
|
||
/* Length of vectors indexed by quantity number.
|
||
We know in advance we will not need a quantity number this big. */
|
||
|
||
static int max_qty;
|
||
|
||
/* Next quantity number to be allocated.
|
||
This is 1 + the largest number needed so far. */
|
||
|
||
static int next_qty;
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by quantity number, gives the first (or last) (pseudo) register
|
||
in the chain of registers that currently contain this quantity. */
|
||
|
||
static int *qty_first_reg;
|
||
static int *qty_last_reg;
|
||
|
||
/* Index by quantity number, gives the mode of the quantity. */
|
||
|
||
static enum machine_mode *qty_mode;
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by quantity number, gives the rtx of the constant value of the
|
||
quantity, or zero if it does not have a known value.
|
||
A sum of the frame pointer (or arg pointer) plus a constant
|
||
can also be entered here. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx *qty_const;
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by qty number, gives the insn that stored the constant value
|
||
recorded in `qty_const'. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx *qty_const_insn;
|
||
|
||
/* The next three variables are used to track when a comparison between a
|
||
quantity and some constant or register has been passed. In that case, we
|
||
know the results of the comparison in case we see it again. These variables
|
||
record a comparison that is known to be true. */
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by qty number, gives the rtx code of a comparison with a known
|
||
result involving this quantity. If none, it is UNKNOWN. */
|
||
static enum rtx_code *qty_comparison_code;
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by qty number, gives the constant being compared against in a
|
||
comparison of known result. If no such comparison, it is undefined.
|
||
If the comparison is not with a constant, it is zero. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx *qty_comparison_const;
|
||
|
||
/* Indexed by qty number, gives the quantity being compared against in a
|
||
comparison of known result. If no such comparison, if it undefined.
|
||
If the comparison is not with a register, it is -1. */
|
||
|
||
static int *qty_comparison_qty;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
/* For machines that have a CC0, we do not record its value in the hash
|
||
table since its use is guaranteed to be the insn immediately following
|
||
its definition and any other insn is presumed to invalidate it.
|
||
|
||
Instead, we store below the value last assigned to CC0. If it should
|
||
happen to be a constant, it is stored in preference to the actual
|
||
assigned value. In case it is a constant, we store the mode in which
|
||
the constant should be interpreted. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx prev_insn_cc0;
|
||
static enum machine_mode prev_insn_cc0_mode;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Previous actual insn. 0 if at first insn of basic block. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx prev_insn;
|
||
|
||
/* Insn being scanned. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx this_insn;
|
||
|
||
/* Index by (pseudo) register number, gives the quantity number
|
||
of the register's current contents. */
|
||
|
||
static int *reg_qty;
|
||
|
||
/* Index by (pseudo) register number, gives the number of the next (or
|
||
previous) (pseudo) register in the chain of registers sharing the same
|
||
value.
|
||
|
||
Or -1 if this register is at the end of the chain.
|
||
|
||
If reg_qty[N] == N, reg_next_eqv[N] is undefined. */
|
||
|
||
static int *reg_next_eqv;
|
||
static int *reg_prev_eqv;
|
||
|
||
/* Index by (pseudo) register number, gives the number of times
|
||
that register has been altered in the current basic block. */
|
||
|
||
static int *reg_tick;
|
||
|
||
/* Index by (pseudo) register number, gives the reg_tick value at which
|
||
rtx's containing this register are valid in the hash table.
|
||
If this does not equal the current reg_tick value, such expressions
|
||
existing in the hash table are invalid.
|
||
If this is -1, no expressions containing this register have been
|
||
entered in the table. */
|
||
|
||
static int *reg_in_table;
|
||
|
||
/* A HARD_REG_SET containing all the hard registers for which there is
|
||
currently a REG expression in the hash table. Note the difference
|
||
from the above variables, which indicate if the REG is mentioned in some
|
||
expression in the table. */
|
||
|
||
static HARD_REG_SET hard_regs_in_table;
|
||
|
||
/* A HARD_REG_SET containing all the hard registers that are invalidated
|
||
by a CALL_INSN. */
|
||
|
||
static HARD_REG_SET regs_invalidated_by_call;
|
||
|
||
/* Two vectors of ints:
|
||
one containing max_reg -1's; the other max_reg + 500 (an approximation
|
||
for max_qty) elements where element i contains i.
|
||
These are used to initialize various other vectors fast. */
|
||
|
||
static int *all_minus_one;
|
||
static int *consec_ints;
|
||
|
||
/* CUID of insn that starts the basic block currently being cse-processed. */
|
||
|
||
static int cse_basic_block_start;
|
||
|
||
/* CUID of insn that ends the basic block currently being cse-processed. */
|
||
|
||
static int cse_basic_block_end;
|
||
|
||
/* Vector mapping INSN_UIDs to cuids.
|
||
The cuids are like uids but increase monotonically always.
|
||
We use them to see whether a reg is used outside a given basic block. */
|
||
|
||
static int *uid_cuid;
|
||
|
||
/* Highest UID in UID_CUID. */
|
||
static int max_uid;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the cuid of an insn. */
|
||
|
||
#define INSN_CUID(INSN) (uid_cuid[INSN_UID (INSN)])
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if cse has altered conditional jump insns
|
||
in such a way that jump optimization should be redone. */
|
||
|
||
static int cse_jumps_altered;
|
||
|
||
/* canon_hash stores 1 in do_not_record
|
||
if it notices a reference to CC0, PC, or some other volatile
|
||
subexpression. */
|
||
|
||
static int do_not_record;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
|
||
|
||
/* Scratch rtl used when looking for load-extended copy of a MEM. */
|
||
static rtx memory_extend_rtx;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* canon_hash stores 1 in hash_arg_in_memory
|
||
if it notices a reference to memory within the expression being hashed. */
|
||
|
||
static int hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
|
||
/* canon_hash stores 1 in hash_arg_in_struct
|
||
if it notices a reference to memory that's part of a structure. */
|
||
|
||
static int hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
/* The hash table contains buckets which are chains of `struct table_elt's,
|
||
each recording one expression's information.
|
||
That expression is in the `exp' field.
|
||
|
||
Those elements with the same hash code are chained in both directions
|
||
through the `next_same_hash' and `prev_same_hash' fields.
|
||
|
||
Each set of expressions with equivalent values
|
||
are on a two-way chain through the `next_same_value'
|
||
and `prev_same_value' fields, and all point with
|
||
the `first_same_value' field at the first element in
|
||
that chain. The chain is in order of increasing cost.
|
||
Each element's cost value is in its `cost' field.
|
||
|
||
The `in_memory' field is nonzero for elements that
|
||
involve any reference to memory. These elements are removed
|
||
whenever a write is done to an unidentified location in memory.
|
||
To be safe, we assume that a memory address is unidentified unless
|
||
the address is either a symbol constant or a constant plus
|
||
the frame pointer or argument pointer.
|
||
|
||
The `in_struct' field is nonzero for elements that
|
||
involve any reference to memory inside a structure or array.
|
||
|
||
The `related_value' field is used to connect related expressions
|
||
(that differ by adding an integer).
|
||
The related expressions are chained in a circular fashion.
|
||
`related_value' is zero for expressions for which this
|
||
chain is not useful.
|
||
|
||
The `cost' field stores the cost of this element's expression.
|
||
|
||
The `is_const' flag is set if the element is a constant (including
|
||
a fixed address).
|
||
|
||
The `flag' field is used as a temporary during some search routines.
|
||
|
||
The `mode' field is usually the same as GET_MODE (`exp'), but
|
||
if `exp' is a CONST_INT and has no machine mode then the `mode'
|
||
field is the mode it was being used as. Each constant is
|
||
recorded separately for each mode it is used with. */
|
||
|
||
|
||
struct table_elt
|
||
{
|
||
rtx exp;
|
||
struct table_elt *next_same_hash;
|
||
struct table_elt *prev_same_hash;
|
||
struct table_elt *next_same_value;
|
||
struct table_elt *prev_same_value;
|
||
struct table_elt *first_same_value;
|
||
struct table_elt *related_value;
|
||
int cost;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
char in_memory;
|
||
char in_struct;
|
||
char is_const;
|
||
char flag;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* We don't want a lot of buckets, because we rarely have very many
|
||
things stored in the hash table, and a lot of buckets slows
|
||
down a lot of loops that happen frequently. */
|
||
#define NBUCKETS 31
|
||
|
||
/* Compute hash code of X in mode M. Special-case case where X is a pseudo
|
||
register (hard registers may require `do_not_record' to be set). */
|
||
|
||
#define HASH(X, M) \
|
||
(GET_CODE (X) == REG && REGNO (X) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER \
|
||
? (((unsigned) REG << 7) + (unsigned) reg_qty[REGNO (X)]) % NBUCKETS \
|
||
: canon_hash (X, M) % NBUCKETS)
|
||
|
||
/* Determine whether register number N is considered a fixed register for CSE.
|
||
It is desirable to replace other regs with fixed regs, to reduce need for
|
||
non-fixed hard regs.
|
||
A reg wins if it is either the frame pointer or designated as fixed,
|
||
but not if it is an overlapping register. */
|
||
#ifdef OVERLAPPING_REGNO_P
|
||
#define FIXED_REGNO_P(N) \
|
||
(((N) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM || (N) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM \
|
||
|| fixed_regs[N] || global_regs[N]) \
|
||
&& ! OVERLAPPING_REGNO_P ((N)))
|
||
#else
|
||
#define FIXED_REGNO_P(N) \
|
||
((N) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM || (N) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM \
|
||
|| fixed_regs[N] || global_regs[N])
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Compute cost of X, as stored in the `cost' field of a table_elt. Fixed
|
||
hard registers and pointers into the frame are the cheapest with a cost
|
||
of 0. Next come pseudos with a cost of one and other hard registers with
|
||
a cost of 2. Aside from these special cases, call `rtx_cost'. */
|
||
|
||
#define CHEAP_REGNO(N) \
|
||
((N) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM || (N) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM \
|
||
|| (N) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM || (N) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM \
|
||
|| ((N) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER && (N) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER) \
|
||
|| ((N) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER \
|
||
&& FIXED_REGNO_P (N) && REGNO_REG_CLASS (N) != NO_REGS))
|
||
|
||
/* A register is cheap if it is a user variable assigned to the register
|
||
or if its register number always corresponds to a cheap register. */
|
||
|
||
#define CHEAP_REG(N) \
|
||
((REG_USERVAR_P (N) && REGNO (N) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) \
|
||
|| CHEAP_REGNO (REGNO (N)))
|
||
|
||
#define COST(X) \
|
||
(GET_CODE (X) == REG \
|
||
? (CHEAP_REG (X) ? 0 \
|
||
: REGNO (X) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1 \
|
||
: 2) \
|
||
: rtx_cost (X, SET) * 2)
|
||
|
||
/* Determine if the quantity number for register X represents a valid index
|
||
into the `qty_...' variables. */
|
||
|
||
#define REGNO_QTY_VALID_P(N) (reg_qty[N] != (N))
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *table[NBUCKETS];
|
||
|
||
/* Chain of `struct table_elt's made so far for this function
|
||
but currently removed from the table. */
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *free_element_chain;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of `struct table_elt' structures made so far for this function. */
|
||
|
||
static int n_elements_made;
|
||
|
||
/* Maximum value `n_elements_made' has had so far in this compilation
|
||
for functions previously processed. */
|
||
|
||
static int max_elements_made;
|
||
|
||
/* Surviving equivalence class when two equivalence classes are merged
|
||
by recording the effects of a jump in the last insn. Zero if the
|
||
last insn was not a conditional jump. */
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *last_jump_equiv_class;
|
||
|
||
/* Set to the cost of a constant pool reference if one was found for a
|
||
symbolic constant. If this was found, it means we should try to
|
||
convert constants into constant pool entries if they don't fit in
|
||
the insn. */
|
||
|
||
static int constant_pool_entries_cost;
|
||
|
||
/* Bits describing what kind of values in memory must be invalidated
|
||
for a particular instruction. If all three bits are zero,
|
||
no memory refs need to be invalidated. Each bit is more powerful
|
||
than the preceding ones, and if a bit is set then the preceding
|
||
bits are also set.
|
||
|
||
Here is how the bits are set:
|
||
Pushing onto the stack invalidates only the stack pointer,
|
||
writing at a fixed address invalidates only variable addresses,
|
||
writing in a structure element at variable address
|
||
invalidates all but scalar variables,
|
||
and writing in anything else at variable address invalidates everything. */
|
||
|
||
struct write_data
|
||
{
|
||
int sp : 1; /* Invalidate stack pointer. */
|
||
int var : 1; /* Invalidate variable addresses. */
|
||
int nonscalar : 1; /* Invalidate all but scalar variables. */
|
||
int all : 1; /* Invalidate all memory refs. */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Define maximum length of a branch path. */
|
||
|
||
#define PATHLENGTH 10
|
||
|
||
/* This data describes a block that will be processed by cse_basic_block. */
|
||
|
||
struct cse_basic_block_data {
|
||
/* Lowest CUID value of insns in block. */
|
||
int low_cuid;
|
||
/* Highest CUID value of insns in block. */
|
||
int high_cuid;
|
||
/* Total number of SETs in block. */
|
||
int nsets;
|
||
/* Last insn in the block. */
|
||
rtx last;
|
||
/* Size of current branch path, if any. */
|
||
int path_size;
|
||
/* Current branch path, indicating which branches will be taken. */
|
||
struct branch_path {
|
||
/* The branch insn. */
|
||
rtx branch;
|
||
/* Whether it should be taken or not. AROUND is the same as taken
|
||
except that it is used when the destination label is not preceded
|
||
by a BARRIER. */
|
||
enum taken {TAKEN, NOT_TAKEN, AROUND} status;
|
||
} path[PATHLENGTH];
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if X has the form (PLUS frame-pointer integer). We check for
|
||
virtual regs here because the simplify_*_operation routines are called
|
||
by integrate.c, which is called before virtual register instantiation. */
|
||
|
||
#define FIXED_BASE_PLUS_P(X) \
|
||
((X) == frame_pointer_rtx || (X) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == arg_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx \
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (X) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 1)) == CONST_INT \
|
||
&& (XEXP (X, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)))
|
||
|
||
/* Similar, but also allows reference to the stack pointer.
|
||
|
||
This used to include FIXED_BASE_PLUS_P, however, we can't assume that
|
||
arg_pointer_rtx by itself is nonzero, because on at least one machine,
|
||
the i960, the arg pointer is zero when it is unused. */
|
||
|
||
#define NONZERO_BASE_PLUS_P(X) \
|
||
((X) == frame_pointer_rtx || (X) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx \
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (X) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 1)) == CONST_INT \
|
||
&& (XEXP (X, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)) \
|
||
|| (X) == stack_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx \
|
||
|| (X) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx \
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (X) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 1)) == CONST_INT \
|
||
&& (XEXP (X, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx \
|
||
|| XEXP (X, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx)))
|
||
|
||
static void new_basic_block PROTO((void));
|
||
static void make_new_qty PROTO((int));
|
||
static void make_regs_eqv PROTO((int, int));
|
||
static void delete_reg_equiv PROTO((int));
|
||
static int mention_regs PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static int insert_regs PROTO((rtx, struct table_elt *, int));
|
||
static void free_element PROTO((struct table_elt *));
|
||
static void remove_from_table PROTO((struct table_elt *, unsigned));
|
||
static struct table_elt *get_element PROTO((void));
|
||
static struct table_elt *lookup PROTO((rtx, unsigned, enum machine_mode)),
|
||
*lookup_for_remove PROTO((rtx, unsigned, enum machine_mode));
|
||
static rtx lookup_as_function PROTO((rtx, enum rtx_code));
|
||
static struct table_elt *insert PROTO((rtx, struct table_elt *, unsigned,
|
||
enum machine_mode));
|
||
static void merge_equiv_classes PROTO((struct table_elt *,
|
||
struct table_elt *));
|
||
static void invalidate PROTO((rtx, enum machine_mode));
|
||
static void remove_invalid_refs PROTO((int));
|
||
static void rehash_using_reg PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static void invalidate_memory PROTO((struct write_data *));
|
||
static void invalidate_for_call PROTO((void));
|
||
static rtx use_related_value PROTO((rtx, struct table_elt *));
|
||
static unsigned canon_hash PROTO((rtx, enum machine_mode));
|
||
static unsigned safe_hash PROTO((rtx, enum machine_mode));
|
||
static int exp_equiv_p PROTO((rtx, rtx, int, int));
|
||
static void set_nonvarying_address_components PROTO((rtx, int, rtx *,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *));
|
||
static int refers_to_p PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static int refers_to_mem_p PROTO((rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT));
|
||
static int cse_rtx_addr_varies_p PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static rtx canon_reg PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static void find_best_addr PROTO((rtx, rtx *));
|
||
static enum rtx_code find_comparison_args PROTO((enum rtx_code, rtx *, rtx *,
|
||
enum machine_mode *,
|
||
enum machine_mode *));
|
||
static rtx cse_gen_binary PROTO((enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode,
|
||
rtx, rtx));
|
||
static rtx simplify_plus_minus PROTO((enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode,
|
||
rtx, rtx));
|
||
static rtx fold_rtx PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static rtx equiv_constant PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static void record_jump_equiv PROTO((rtx, int));
|
||
static void record_jump_cond PROTO((enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode,
|
||
rtx, rtx, int));
|
||
static void cse_insn PROTO((rtx, int));
|
||
static void note_mem_written PROTO((rtx, struct write_data *));
|
||
static void invalidate_from_clobbers PROTO((struct write_data *, rtx));
|
||
static rtx cse_process_notes PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static void cse_around_loop PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static void invalidate_skipped_set PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static void invalidate_skipped_block PROTO((rtx));
|
||
static void cse_check_loop_start PROTO((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static void cse_set_around_loop PROTO((rtx, rtx, rtx));
|
||
static rtx cse_basic_block PROTO((rtx, rtx, struct branch_path *, int));
|
||
static void count_reg_usage PROTO((rtx, int *, rtx, int));
|
||
|
||
extern int rtx_equal_function_value_matters;
|
||
|
||
/* Return an estimate of the cost of computing rtx X.
|
||
One use is in cse, to decide which expression to keep in the hash table.
|
||
Another is in rtl generation, to pick the cheapest way to multiply.
|
||
Other uses like the latter are expected in the future. */
|
||
|
||
/* Return the right cost to give to an operation
|
||
to make the cost of the corresponding register-to-register instruction
|
||
N times that of a fast register-to-register instruction. */
|
||
|
||
#define COSTS_N_INSNS(N) ((N) * 4 - 2)
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
rtx_cost (x, outer_code)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
enum rtx_code outer_code;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i, j;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
register int total;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the default costs of certain things.
|
||
Note that RTX_COSTS can override the defaults. */
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
/* Count multiplication by 2**n as a shift,
|
||
because if we are considering it, we would output it as a shift. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))) >= 0)
|
||
total = 2;
|
||
else
|
||
total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DIV:
|
||
case UDIV:
|
||
case MOD:
|
||
case UMOD:
|
||
total = COSTS_N_INSNS (7);
|
||
break;
|
||
case USE:
|
||
/* Used in loop.c and combine.c as a marker. */
|
||
total = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
case ASM_OPERANDS:
|
||
/* We don't want these to be used in substitutions because
|
||
we have no way of validating the resulting insn. So assign
|
||
anything containing an ASM_OPERANDS a very high cost. */
|
||
total = 1000;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
total = 2;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
return ! CHEAP_REG (x);
|
||
|
||
case SUBREG:
|
||
/* If we can't tie these modes, make this expensive. The larger
|
||
the mode, the more expensive it is. */
|
||
if (! MODES_TIEABLE_P (GET_MODE (x), GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
|
||
return COSTS_N_INSNS (2
|
||
+ GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) / UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
return 2;
|
||
#ifdef RTX_COSTS
|
||
RTX_COSTS (x, code, outer_code);
|
||
#endif
|
||
CONST_COSTS (x, code, outer_code);
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Sum the costs of the sub-rtx's, plus cost of this operation,
|
||
which is already in total. */
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
total += rtx_cost (XEXP (x, i), code);
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
total += rtx_cost (XVECEXP (x, i, j), code);
|
||
|
||
return total;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the hash table and initialize each register with its own quantity,
|
||
for a new basic block. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
new_basic_block ()
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
|
||
next_qty = max_reg;
|
||
|
||
bzero ((char *) reg_tick, max_reg * sizeof (int));
|
||
|
||
bcopy ((char *) all_minus_one, (char *) reg_in_table,
|
||
max_reg * sizeof (int));
|
||
bcopy ((char *) consec_ints, (char *) reg_qty, max_reg * sizeof (int));
|
||
CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (hard_regs_in_table);
|
||
|
||
/* The per-quantity values used to be initialized here, but it is
|
||
much faster to initialize each as it is made in `make_new_qty'. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *this, *next;
|
||
for (this = table[i]; this; this = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = this->next_same_hash;
|
||
free_element (this);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bzero ((char *) table, sizeof table);
|
||
|
||
prev_insn = 0;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
prev_insn_cc0 = 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Say that register REG contains a quantity not in any register before
|
||
and initialize that quantity. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
make_new_qty (reg)
|
||
register int reg;
|
||
{
|
||
register int q;
|
||
|
||
if (next_qty >= max_qty)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
q = reg_qty[reg] = next_qty++;
|
||
qty_first_reg[q] = reg;
|
||
qty_last_reg[q] = reg;
|
||
qty_const[q] = qty_const_insn[q] = 0;
|
||
qty_comparison_code[q] = UNKNOWN;
|
||
|
||
reg_next_eqv[reg] = reg_prev_eqv[reg] = -1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Make reg NEW equivalent to reg OLD.
|
||
OLD is not changing; NEW is. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
make_regs_eqv (new, old)
|
||
register int new, old;
|
||
{
|
||
register int lastr, firstr;
|
||
register int q = reg_qty[old];
|
||
|
||
/* Nothing should become eqv until it has a "non-invalid" qty number. */
|
||
if (! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (old))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
reg_qty[new] = q;
|
||
firstr = qty_first_reg[q];
|
||
lastr = qty_last_reg[q];
|
||
|
||
/* Prefer fixed hard registers to anything. Prefer pseudo regs to other
|
||
hard regs. Among pseudos, if NEW will live longer than any other reg
|
||
of the same qty, and that is beyond the current basic block,
|
||
make it the new canonical replacement for this qty. */
|
||
if (! (firstr < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER && FIXED_REGNO_P (firstr))
|
||
/* Certain fixed registers might be of the class NO_REGS. This means
|
||
that not only can they not be allocated by the compiler, but
|
||
they cannot be used in substitutions or canonicalizations
|
||
either. */
|
||
&& (new >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || REGNO_REG_CLASS (new) != NO_REGS)
|
||
&& ((new < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER && FIXED_REGNO_P (new))
|
||
|| (new >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& (firstr < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
|| ((uid_cuid[regno_last_uid[new]] > cse_basic_block_end
|
||
|| (uid_cuid[regno_first_uid[new]]
|
||
< cse_basic_block_start))
|
||
&& (uid_cuid[regno_last_uid[new]]
|
||
> uid_cuid[regno_last_uid[firstr]]))))))
|
||
{
|
||
reg_prev_eqv[firstr] = new;
|
||
reg_next_eqv[new] = firstr;
|
||
reg_prev_eqv[new] = -1;
|
||
qty_first_reg[q] = new;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* If NEW is a hard reg (known to be non-fixed), insert at end.
|
||
Otherwise, insert before any non-fixed hard regs that are at the
|
||
end. Registers of class NO_REGS cannot be used as an
|
||
equivalent for anything. */
|
||
while (lastr < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER && reg_prev_eqv[lastr] >= 0
|
||
&& (REGNO_REG_CLASS (lastr) == NO_REGS || ! FIXED_REGNO_P (lastr))
|
||
&& new >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
lastr = reg_prev_eqv[lastr];
|
||
reg_next_eqv[new] = reg_next_eqv[lastr];
|
||
if (reg_next_eqv[lastr] >= 0)
|
||
reg_prev_eqv[reg_next_eqv[lastr]] = new;
|
||
else
|
||
qty_last_reg[q] = new;
|
||
reg_next_eqv[lastr] = new;
|
||
reg_prev_eqv[new] = lastr;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove REG from its equivalence class. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
delete_reg_equiv (reg)
|
||
register int reg;
|
||
{
|
||
register int q = reg_qty[reg];
|
||
register int p, n;
|
||
|
||
/* If invalid, do nothing. */
|
||
if (q == reg)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
p = reg_prev_eqv[reg];
|
||
n = reg_next_eqv[reg];
|
||
|
||
if (n != -1)
|
||
reg_prev_eqv[n] = p;
|
||
else
|
||
qty_last_reg[q] = p;
|
||
if (p != -1)
|
||
reg_next_eqv[p] = n;
|
||
else
|
||
qty_first_reg[q] = n;
|
||
|
||
reg_qty[reg] = reg;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove any invalid expressions from the hash table
|
||
that refer to any of the registers contained in expression X.
|
||
|
||
Make sure that newly inserted references to those registers
|
||
as subexpressions will be considered valid.
|
||
|
||
mention_regs is not called when a register itself
|
||
is being stored in the table.
|
||
|
||
Return 1 if we have done something that may have changed the hash code
|
||
of X. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mention_regs (x)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register int i, j;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
register int changed = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
if (code == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
register int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
register int endregno
|
||
= regno + (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
|
||
: HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x)));
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (reg_in_table[i] >= 0 && reg_in_table[i] != reg_tick[i])
|
||
remove_invalid_refs (i);
|
||
|
||
reg_in_table[i] = reg_tick[i];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a comparison or a COMPARE and either operand is a register
|
||
that does not have a quantity, give it one. This is so that a later
|
||
call to record_jump_equiv won't cause X to be assigned a different
|
||
hash code and not found in the table after that call.
|
||
|
||
It is not necessary to do this here, since rehash_using_reg can
|
||
fix up the table later, but doing this here eliminates the need to
|
||
call that expensive function in the most common case where the only
|
||
use of the register is in the comparison. */
|
||
|
||
if (code == COMPARE || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == '<')
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 0))))
|
||
if (insert_regs (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (XEXP (x, 0));
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == REG
|
||
&& ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 1))))
|
||
if (insert_regs (XEXP (x, 1), NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (XEXP (x, 1));
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
changed |= mention_regs (XEXP (x, i));
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
changed |= mention_regs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
|
||
|
||
return changed;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Update the register quantities for inserting X into the hash table
|
||
with a value equivalent to CLASSP.
|
||
(If the class does not contain a REG, it is irrelevant.)
|
||
If MODIFIED is nonzero, X is a destination; it is being modified.
|
||
Note that delete_reg_equiv should be called on a register
|
||
before insert_regs is done on that register with MODIFIED != 0.
|
||
|
||
Nonzero value means that elements of reg_qty have changed
|
||
so X's hash code may be different. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
insert_regs (x, classp, modified)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
struct table_elt *classp;
|
||
int modified;
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
register int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
|
||
/* If REGNO is in the equivalence table already but is of the
|
||
wrong mode for that equivalence, don't do anything here. */
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (regno)
|
||
&& qty_mode[reg_qty[regno]] != GET_MODE (x))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (modified || ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (regno))
|
||
{
|
||
if (classp)
|
||
for (classp = classp->first_same_value;
|
||
classp != 0;
|
||
classp = classp->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (classp->exp) == REG
|
||
&& GET_MODE (classp->exp) == GET_MODE (x))
|
||
{
|
||
make_regs_eqv (regno, REGNO (classp->exp));
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
make_new_qty (regno);
|
||
qty_mode[reg_qty[regno]] = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a SUBREG, we will likely be inserting the inner register in the
|
||
table. If that register doesn't have an assigned quantity number at
|
||
this point but does later, the insertion that we will be doing now will
|
||
not be accessible because its hash code will have changed. So assign
|
||
a quantity number now. */
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
|
||
&& ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))))
|
||
{
|
||
insert_regs (SUBREG_REG (x), NULL_PTR, 0);
|
||
mention_regs (SUBREG_REG (x));
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return mention_regs (x);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Look in or update the hash table. */
|
||
|
||
/* Put the element ELT on the list of free elements. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
free_element (elt)
|
||
struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
{
|
||
elt->next_same_hash = free_element_chain;
|
||
free_element_chain = elt;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return an element that is free for use. */
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *
|
||
get_element ()
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *elt = free_element_chain;
|
||
if (elt)
|
||
{
|
||
free_element_chain = elt->next_same_hash;
|
||
return elt;
|
||
}
|
||
n_elements_made++;
|
||
return (struct table_elt *) oballoc (sizeof (struct table_elt));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove table element ELT from use in the table.
|
||
HASH is its hash code, made using the HASH macro.
|
||
It's an argument because often that is known in advance
|
||
and we save much time not recomputing it. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
remove_from_table (elt, hash)
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
{
|
||
if (elt == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Mark this element as removed. See cse_insn. */
|
||
elt->first_same_value = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Remove the table element from its equivalence class. */
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *prev = elt->prev_same_value;
|
||
register struct table_elt *next = elt->next_same_value;
|
||
|
||
if (next) next->prev_same_value = prev;
|
||
|
||
if (prev)
|
||
prev->next_same_value = next;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *newfirst = next;
|
||
while (next)
|
||
{
|
||
next->first_same_value = newfirst;
|
||
next = next->next_same_value;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove the table element from its hash bucket. */
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *prev = elt->prev_same_hash;
|
||
register struct table_elt *next = elt->next_same_hash;
|
||
|
||
if (next) next->prev_same_hash = prev;
|
||
|
||
if (prev)
|
||
prev->next_same_hash = next;
|
||
else if (table[hash] == elt)
|
||
table[hash] = next;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This entry is not in the proper hash bucket. This can happen
|
||
when two classes were merged by `merge_equiv_classes'. Search
|
||
for the hash bucket that it heads. This happens only very
|
||
rarely, so the cost is acceptable. */
|
||
for (hash = 0; hash < NBUCKETS; hash++)
|
||
if (table[hash] == elt)
|
||
table[hash] = next;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove the table element from its related-value circular chain. */
|
||
|
||
if (elt->related_value != 0 && elt->related_value != elt)
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p = elt->related_value;
|
||
while (p->related_value != elt)
|
||
p = p->related_value;
|
||
p->related_value = elt->related_value;
|
||
if (p->related_value == p)
|
||
p->related_value = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
free_element (elt);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Look up X in the hash table and return its table element,
|
||
or 0 if X is not in the table.
|
||
|
||
MODE is the machine-mode of X, or if X is an integer constant
|
||
with VOIDmode then MODE is the mode with which X will be used.
|
||
|
||
Here we are satisfied to find an expression whose tree structure
|
||
looks like X. */
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *
|
||
lookup (x, hash, mode)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p;
|
||
|
||
for (p = table[hash]; p; p = p->next_same_hash)
|
||
if (mode == p->mode && ((x == p->exp && GET_CODE (x) == REG)
|
||
|| exp_equiv_p (x, p->exp, GET_CODE (x) != REG, 0)))
|
||
return p;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Like `lookup' but don't care whether the table element uses invalid regs.
|
||
Also ignore discrepancies in the machine mode of a register. */
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *
|
||
lookup_for_remove (x, hash, mode)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
/* Don't check the machine mode when comparing registers;
|
||
invalidating (REG:SI 0) also invalidates (REG:DF 0). */
|
||
for (p = table[hash]; p; p = p->next_same_hash)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (p->exp) == regno)
|
||
return p;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
for (p = table[hash]; p; p = p->next_same_hash)
|
||
if (mode == p->mode && (x == p->exp || exp_equiv_p (x, p->exp, 0, 0)))
|
||
return p;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Look for an expression equivalent to X and with code CODE.
|
||
If one is found, return that expression. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
lookup_as_function (x, code)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p = lookup (x, safe_hash (x, VOIDmode) % NBUCKETS,
|
||
GET_MODE (x));
|
||
if (p == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
for (p = p->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == code
|
||
/* Make sure this is a valid entry in the table. */
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
return p->exp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Insert X in the hash table, assuming HASH is its hash code
|
||
and CLASSP is an element of the class it should go in
|
||
(or 0 if a new class should be made).
|
||
It is inserted at the proper position to keep the class in
|
||
the order cheapest first.
|
||
|
||
MODE is the machine-mode of X, or if X is an integer constant
|
||
with VOIDmode then MODE is the mode with which X will be used.
|
||
|
||
For elements of equal cheapness, the most recent one
|
||
goes in front, except that the first element in the list
|
||
remains first unless a cheaper element is added. The order of
|
||
pseudo-registers does not matter, as canon_reg will be called to
|
||
find the cheapest when a register is retrieved from the table.
|
||
|
||
The in_memory field in the hash table element is set to 0.
|
||
The caller must set it nonzero if appropriate.
|
||
|
||
You should call insert_regs (X, CLASSP, MODIFY) before calling here,
|
||
and if insert_regs returns a nonzero value
|
||
you must then recompute its hash code before calling here.
|
||
|
||
If necessary, update table showing constant values of quantities. */
|
||
|
||
#define CHEAPER(X,Y) ((X)->cost < (Y)->cost)
|
||
|
||
static struct table_elt *
|
||
insert (x, classp, hash, mode)
|
||
register rtx x;
|
||
register struct table_elt *classp;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a register and we haven't made a quantity for it,
|
||
something is wrong. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (x)))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a hard register, show it is being put in the table. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
{
|
||
int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
int endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
|
||
SET_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, i);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Put an element for X into the right hash bucket. */
|
||
|
||
elt = get_element ();
|
||
elt->exp = x;
|
||
elt->cost = COST (x);
|
||
elt->next_same_value = 0;
|
||
elt->prev_same_value = 0;
|
||
elt->next_same_hash = table[hash];
|
||
elt->prev_same_hash = 0;
|
||
elt->related_value = 0;
|
||
elt->in_memory = 0;
|
||
elt->mode = mode;
|
||
elt->is_const = (CONSTANT_P (x)
|
||
/* GNU C++ takes advantage of this for `this'
|
||
(and other const values). */
|
||
|| (RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x)
|
||
&& GET_CODE (x) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
|| FIXED_BASE_PLUS_P (x));
|
||
|
||
if (table[hash])
|
||
table[hash]->prev_same_hash = elt;
|
||
table[hash] = elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Put it into the proper value-class. */
|
||
if (classp)
|
||
{
|
||
classp = classp->first_same_value;
|
||
if (CHEAPER (elt, classp))
|
||
/* Insert at the head of the class */
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p;
|
||
elt->next_same_value = classp;
|
||
classp->prev_same_value = elt;
|
||
elt->first_same_value = elt;
|
||
|
||
for (p = classp; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
p->first_same_value = elt;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Insert not at head of the class. */
|
||
/* Put it after the last element cheaper than X. */
|
||
register struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
for (p = classp; (next = p->next_same_value) && CHEAPER (next, elt);
|
||
p = next);
|
||
/* Put it after P and before NEXT. */
|
||
elt->next_same_value = next;
|
||
if (next)
|
||
next->prev_same_value = elt;
|
||
elt->prev_same_value = p;
|
||
p->next_same_value = elt;
|
||
elt->first_same_value = classp;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
elt->first_same_value = elt;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a constant being set equivalent to a register or a register
|
||
being set equivalent to a constant, note the constant equivalence.
|
||
|
||
If this is a constant, it cannot be equivalent to a different constant,
|
||
and a constant is the only thing that can be cheaper than a register. So
|
||
we know the register is the head of the class (before the constant was
|
||
inserted).
|
||
|
||
If this is a register that is not already known equivalent to a
|
||
constant, we must check the entire class.
|
||
|
||
If this is a register that is already known equivalent to an insn,
|
||
update `qty_const_insn' to show that `this_insn' is the latest
|
||
insn making that quantity equivalent to the constant. */
|
||
|
||
if (elt->is_const && classp && GET_CODE (classp->exp) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (classp->exp)]]
|
||
= gen_lowpart_if_possible (qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (classp->exp)]], x);
|
||
qty_const_insn[reg_qty[REGNO (classp->exp)]] = this_insn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && classp && ! qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]])
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *p;
|
||
|
||
for (p = classp; p != 0; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->is_const)
|
||
{
|
||
qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]]
|
||
= gen_lowpart_if_possible (GET_MODE (x), p->exp);
|
||
qty_const_insn[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]] = this_insn;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]]
|
||
&& GET_MODE (x) == qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]])
|
||
qty_const_insn[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]] = this_insn;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a constant with symbolic value,
|
||
and it has a term with an explicit integer value,
|
||
link it up with related expressions. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx subexp = get_related_value (x);
|
||
unsigned subhash;
|
||
struct table_elt *subelt, *subelt_prev;
|
||
|
||
if (subexp != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Get the integer-free subexpression in the hash table. */
|
||
subhash = safe_hash (subexp, mode) % NBUCKETS;
|
||
subelt = lookup (subexp, subhash, mode);
|
||
if (subelt == 0)
|
||
subelt = insert (subexp, NULL_PTR, subhash, mode);
|
||
/* Initialize SUBELT's circular chain if it has none. */
|
||
if (subelt->related_value == 0)
|
||
subelt->related_value = subelt;
|
||
/* Find the element in the circular chain that precedes SUBELT. */
|
||
subelt_prev = subelt;
|
||
while (subelt_prev->related_value != subelt)
|
||
subelt_prev = subelt_prev->related_value;
|
||
/* Put new ELT into SUBELT's circular chain just before SUBELT.
|
||
This way the element that follows SUBELT is the oldest one. */
|
||
elt->related_value = subelt_prev->related_value;
|
||
subelt_prev->related_value = elt;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return elt;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given two equivalence classes, CLASS1 and CLASS2, put all the entries from
|
||
CLASS2 into CLASS1. This is done when we have reached an insn which makes
|
||
the two classes equivalent.
|
||
|
||
CLASS1 will be the surviving class; CLASS2 should not be used after this
|
||
call.
|
||
|
||
Any invalid entries in CLASS2 will not be copied. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (class1, class2)
|
||
struct table_elt *class1, *class2;
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *elt, *next, *new;
|
||
|
||
/* Ensure we start with the head of the classes. */
|
||
class1 = class1->first_same_value;
|
||
class2 = class2->first_same_value;
|
||
|
||
/* If they were already equal, forget it. */
|
||
if (class1 == class2)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
for (elt = class2; elt; elt = next)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
rtx exp = elt->exp;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = elt->mode;
|
||
|
||
next = elt->next_same_value;
|
||
|
||
/* Remove old entry, make a new one in CLASS1's class.
|
||
Don't do this for invalid entries as we cannot find their
|
||
hash code (it also isn't necessary). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (exp) == REG || exp_equiv_p (exp, exp, 1, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
hash = HASH (exp, mode);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (exp) == REG)
|
||
delete_reg_equiv (REGNO (exp));
|
||
|
||
remove_from_table (elt, hash);
|
||
|
||
if (insert_regs (exp, class1, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (exp);
|
||
hash = HASH (exp, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
new = insert (exp, class1, hash, mode);
|
||
new->in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
new->in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove from the hash table, or mark as invalid,
|
||
all expressions whose values could be altered by storing in X.
|
||
X is a register, a subreg, or a memory reference with nonvarying address
|
||
(because, when a memory reference with a varying address is stored in,
|
||
all memory references are removed by invalidate_memory
|
||
so specific invalidation is superfluous).
|
||
FULL_MODE, if not VOIDmode, indicates that this much should be invalidated
|
||
instead of just the amount indicated by the mode of X. This is only used
|
||
for bitfield stores into memory.
|
||
|
||
A nonvarying address may be just a register or just
|
||
a symbol reference, or it may be either of those plus
|
||
a numeric offset. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate (x, full_mode)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
enum machine_mode full_mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
register struct table_elt *p;
|
||
rtx base;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT start, end;
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a register, dependencies on its contents
|
||
are recorded through the qty number mechanism.
|
||
Just change the qty number of the register,
|
||
mark it as invalid for expressions that refer to it,
|
||
and remove it itself. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
register int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
register unsigned hash = HASH (x, GET_MODE (x));
|
||
|
||
/* Remove REGNO from any quantity list it might be on and indicate
|
||
that it's value might have changed. If it is a pseudo, remove its
|
||
entry from the hash table.
|
||
|
||
For a hard register, we do the first two actions above for any
|
||
additional hard registers corresponding to X. Then, if any of these
|
||
registers are in the table, we must remove any REG entries that
|
||
overlap these registers. */
|
||
|
||
delete_reg_equiv (regno);
|
||
reg_tick[regno]++;
|
||
|
||
if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
remove_from_table (lookup_for_remove (x, hash, GET_MODE (x)), hash);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT in_table
|
||
= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, regno);
|
||
int endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
|
||
int tregno, tendregno;
|
||
register struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
|
||
CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, regno);
|
||
|
||
for (i = regno + 1; i < endregno; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
in_table |= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, i);
|
||
CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, i);
|
||
delete_reg_equiv (i);
|
||
reg_tick[i]++;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (in_table)
|
||
for (hash = 0; hash < NBUCKETS; hash++)
|
||
for (p = table[hash]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (p->exp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
tregno = REGNO (p->exp);
|
||
tendregno
|
||
= tregno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (tregno, GET_MODE (p->exp));
|
||
if (tendregno > regno && tregno < endregno)
|
||
remove_from_table (p, hash);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) != REG)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
invalidate (SUBREG_REG (x), VOIDmode);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* X is not a register; it must be a memory reference with
|
||
a nonvarying address. Remove all hash table elements
|
||
that refer to overlapping pieces of memory. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (full_mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
full_mode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
|
||
set_nonvarying_address_components (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE_SIZE (full_mode),
|
||
&base, &start, &end);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *next;
|
||
for (p = table[i]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
if (refers_to_mem_p (p->exp, base, start, end))
|
||
remove_from_table (p, i);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove all expressions that refer to register REGNO,
|
||
since they are already invalid, and we are about to
|
||
mark that register valid again and don't want the old
|
||
expressions to reappear as valid. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
remove_invalid_refs (regno)
|
||
int regno;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
register struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
|
||
for (p = table[i]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) != REG
|
||
&& refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + 1, p->exp, NULL_PTR))
|
||
remove_from_table (p, i);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Recompute the hash codes of any valid entries in the hash table that
|
||
reference X, if X is a register, or SUBREG_REG (X) if X is a SUBREG.
|
||
|
||
This is called when we make a jump equivalence. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
rehash_using_reg (x)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
|
||
x = SUBREG_REG (x);
|
||
|
||
/* If X is not a register or if the register is known not to be in any
|
||
valid entries in the table, we have no work to do. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != REG
|
||
|| reg_in_table[REGNO (x)] < 0
|
||
|| reg_in_table[REGNO (x)] != reg_tick[REGNO (x)])
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Scan all hash chains looking for valid entries that mention X.
|
||
If we find one and it is in the wrong hash chain, move it. We can skip
|
||
objects that are registers, since they are handled specially. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
|
||
for (p = table[i]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) != REG && reg_mentioned_p (x, p->exp)
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0)
|
||
&& i != (hash = safe_hash (p->exp, p->mode) % NBUCKETS))
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->next_same_hash)
|
||
p->next_same_hash->prev_same_hash = p->prev_same_hash;
|
||
|
||
if (p->prev_same_hash)
|
||
p->prev_same_hash->next_same_hash = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
else
|
||
table[i] = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
|
||
p->next_same_hash = table[hash];
|
||
p->prev_same_hash = 0;
|
||
if (table[hash])
|
||
table[hash]->prev_same_hash = p;
|
||
table[hash] = p;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove from the hash table all expressions that reference memory,
|
||
or some of them as specified by *WRITES. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate_memory (writes)
|
||
struct write_data *writes;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
register struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
int all = writes->all;
|
||
int nonscalar = writes->nonscalar;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
|
||
for (p = table[i]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
if (p->in_memory
|
||
&& (all
|
||
|| (nonscalar && p->in_struct)
|
||
|| cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (p->exp)))
|
||
remove_from_table (p, i);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove from the hash table any expression that is a call-clobbered
|
||
register. Also update their TICK values. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate_for_call ()
|
||
{
|
||
int regno, endregno;
|
||
int i;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
struct table_elt *p, *next;
|
||
int in_table = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Go through all the hard registers. For each that is clobbered in
|
||
a CALL_INSN, remove the register from quantity chains and update
|
||
reg_tick if defined. Also see if any of these registers is currently
|
||
in the table. */
|
||
|
||
for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
|
||
if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, regno))
|
||
{
|
||
delete_reg_equiv (regno);
|
||
if (reg_tick[regno] >= 0)
|
||
reg_tick[regno]++;
|
||
|
||
in_table |= (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, regno) != 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In the case where we have no call-clobbered hard registers in the
|
||
table, we are done. Otherwise, scan the table and remove any
|
||
entry that overlaps a call-clobbered register. */
|
||
|
||
if (in_table)
|
||
for (hash = 0; hash < NBUCKETS; hash++)
|
||
for (p = table[hash]; p; p = next)
|
||
{
|
||
next = p->next_same_hash;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (p->exp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
regno = REGNO (p->exp);
|
||
endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (p->exp));
|
||
|
||
for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
|
||
if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, i))
|
||
{
|
||
remove_from_table (p, hash);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given an expression X of type CONST,
|
||
and ELT which is its table entry (or 0 if it
|
||
is not in the hash table),
|
||
return an alternate expression for X as a register plus integer.
|
||
If none can be found, return 0. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
use_related_value (x, elt)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *relt = 0;
|
||
register struct table_elt *p, *q;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
|
||
/* First, is there anything related known?
|
||
If we have a table element, we can tell from that.
|
||
Otherwise, must look it up. */
|
||
|
||
if (elt != 0 && elt->related_value != 0)
|
||
relt = elt;
|
||
else if (elt == 0 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx subexp = get_related_value (x);
|
||
if (subexp != 0)
|
||
relt = lookup (subexp,
|
||
safe_hash (subexp, GET_MODE (subexp)) % NBUCKETS,
|
||
GET_MODE (subexp));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (relt == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Search all related table entries for one that has an
|
||
equivalent register. */
|
||
|
||
p = relt;
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This loop is strange in that it is executed in two different cases.
|
||
The first is when X is already in the table. Then it is searching
|
||
the RELATED_VALUE list of X's class (RELT). The second case is when
|
||
X is not in the table. Then RELT points to a class for the related
|
||
value.
|
||
|
||
Ensure that, whatever case we are in, that we ignore classes that have
|
||
the same value as X. */
|
||
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (x, p->exp))
|
||
q = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
for (q = p->first_same_value; q; q = q->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (q->exp) == REG)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (q)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
p = p->related_value;
|
||
|
||
/* We went all the way around, so there is nothing to be found.
|
||
Alternatively, perhaps RELT was in the table for some other reason
|
||
and it has no related values recorded. */
|
||
if (p == relt || p == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (q == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
offset = (get_integer_term (x) - get_integer_term (p->exp));
|
||
/* Note: OFFSET may be 0 if P->xexp and X are related by commutativity. */
|
||
return plus_constant (q->exp, offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Hash an rtx. We are careful to make sure the value is never negative.
|
||
Equivalent registers hash identically.
|
||
MODE is used in hashing for CONST_INTs only;
|
||
otherwise the mode of X is used.
|
||
|
||
Store 1 in do_not_record if any subexpression is volatile.
|
||
|
||
Store 1 in hash_arg_in_memory if X contains a MEM rtx
|
||
which does not have the RTX_UNCHANGING_P bit set.
|
||
In this case, also store 1 in hash_arg_in_struct
|
||
if there is a MEM rtx which has the MEM_IN_STRUCT_P bit set.
|
||
|
||
Note that cse_insn knows that the hash code of a MEM expression
|
||
is just (int) MEM plus the hash code of the address. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned
|
||
canon_hash (x, mode)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i, j;
|
||
register unsigned hash = 0;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
|
||
/* repeat is used to turn tail-recursion into iteration. */
|
||
repeat:
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return hash;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
{
|
||
register int regno = REGNO (x);
|
||
|
||
/* On some machines, we can't record any non-fixed hard register,
|
||
because extending its life will cause reload problems. We
|
||
consider ap, fp, and sp to be fixed for this purpose.
|
||
On all machines, we can't record any global registers. */
|
||
|
||
if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& (global_regs[regno]
|
||
#ifdef SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
||
|| (! fixed_regs[regno]
|
||
&& regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& regno != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& regno != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
#endif
|
||
))
|
||
{
|
||
do_not_record = 1;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
hash += ((unsigned) REG << 7) + (unsigned) reg_qty[regno];
|
||
return hash;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT tem = INTVAL (x);
|
||
hash += ((unsigned) CONST_INT << 7) + (unsigned) mode + tem;
|
||
return hash;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
/* This is like the general case, except that it only counts
|
||
the integers representing the constant. */
|
||
hash += (unsigned) code + (unsigned) GET_MODE (x);
|
||
for (i = 2; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (CONST_DOUBLE); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned tem = XINT (x, i);
|
||
hash += tem;
|
||
}
|
||
return hash;
|
||
|
||
/* Assume there is only one rtx object for any given label. */
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
hash
|
||
+= ((unsigned) LABEL_REF << 7) + (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
return hash;
|
||
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
hash
|
||
+= ((unsigned) SYMBOL_REF << 7) + (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) XSTR (x, 0);
|
||
return hash;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
if (MEM_VOLATILE_P (x))
|
||
{
|
||
do_not_record = 1;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
if (! RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x))
|
||
{
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 1;
|
||
if (MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (x)) hash_arg_in_struct = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Now that we have already found this special case,
|
||
might as well speed it up as much as possible. */
|
||
hash += (unsigned) MEM;
|
||
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
goto repeat;
|
||
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case POST_DEC:
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
case PC:
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
case CALL:
|
||
case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
|
||
do_not_record = 1;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case ASM_OPERANDS:
|
||
if (MEM_VOLATILE_P (x))
|
||
{
|
||
do_not_record = 1;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1;
|
||
hash += (unsigned) code + (unsigned) GET_MODE (x);
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
{
|
||
rtx tem = XEXP (x, i);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are about to do the last recursive call
|
||
needed at this level, change it into iteration.
|
||
This function is called enough to be worth it. */
|
||
if (i == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
x = tem;
|
||
goto repeat;
|
||
}
|
||
hash += canon_hash (tem, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
hash += canon_hash (XVECEXP (x, i, j), 0);
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 's')
|
||
{
|
||
register unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *) XSTR (x, i);
|
||
if (p)
|
||
while (*p)
|
||
hash += *p++;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'i')
|
||
{
|
||
register unsigned tem = XINT (x, i);
|
||
hash += tem;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
return hash;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Like canon_hash but with no side effects. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned
|
||
safe_hash (x, mode)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
int save_do_not_record = do_not_record;
|
||
int save_hash_arg_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
int save_hash_arg_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
unsigned hash = canon_hash (x, mode);
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = save_hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = save_hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
do_not_record = save_do_not_record;
|
||
return hash;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 iff X and Y would canonicalize into the same thing,
|
||
without actually constructing the canonicalization of either one.
|
||
If VALIDATE is nonzero,
|
||
we assume X is an expression being processed from the rtl
|
||
and Y was found in the hash table. We check register refs
|
||
in Y for being marked as valid.
|
||
|
||
If EQUAL_VALUES is nonzero, we allow a register to match a constant value
|
||
that is known to be in the register. Ordinarily, we don't allow them
|
||
to match, because letting them match would cause unpredictable results
|
||
in all the places that search a hash table chain for an equivalent
|
||
for a given value. A possible equivalent that has different structure
|
||
has its hash code computed from different data. Whether the hash code
|
||
is the same as that of the the given value is pure luck. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
exp_equiv_p (x, y, validate, equal_values)
|
||
rtx x, y;
|
||
int validate;
|
||
int equal_values;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i, j;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
|
||
/* Note: it is incorrect to assume an expression is equivalent to itself
|
||
if VALIDATE is nonzero. */
|
||
if (x == y && !validate)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
if (x == 0 || y == 0)
|
||
return x == y;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
if (code != GET_CODE (y))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!equal_values)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a constant and Y is a register or vice versa, they may be
|
||
equivalent. We only have to validate if Y is a register. */
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (x) && GET_CODE (y) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (y))
|
||
&& GET_MODE (y) == qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (y)]]
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (x, qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (y)]])
|
||
&& (! validate || reg_in_table[REGNO (y)] == reg_tick[REGNO (y)]))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (y) && code == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (x))
|
||
&& GET_MODE (x) == qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]]
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (y, qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]]))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* (MULT:SI x y) and (MULT:HI x y) are NOT equivalent. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (y))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PC:
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
return x == y;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
return INTVAL (x) == INTVAL (y);
|
||
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
return XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (y, 0);
|
||
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
return XSTR (x, 0) == XSTR (y, 0);
|
||
|
||
case REG:
|
||
{
|
||
int regno = REGNO (y);
|
||
int endregno
|
||
= regno + (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
|
||
: HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (y)));
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
/* If the quantities are not the same, the expressions are not
|
||
equivalent. If there are and we are not to validate, they
|
||
are equivalent. Otherwise, ensure all regs are up-to-date. */
|
||
|
||
if (reg_qty[REGNO (x)] != reg_qty[regno])
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (! validate)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
|
||
if (reg_in_table[i] != reg_tick[i])
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For commutative operations, check both orders. */
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
case AND:
|
||
case IOR:
|
||
case XOR:
|
||
case NE:
|
||
case EQ:
|
||
return ((exp_equiv_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (y, 0), validate, equal_values)
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (XEXP (x, 1), XEXP (y, 1),
|
||
validate, equal_values))
|
||
|| (exp_equiv_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (y, 1),
|
||
validate, equal_values)
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (XEXP (x, 1), XEXP (y, 0),
|
||
validate, equal_values)));
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compare the elements. If any pair of corresponding elements
|
||
fail to match, return 0 for the whole things. */
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (fmt[i])
|
||
{
|
||
case 'e':
|
||
if (! exp_equiv_p (XEXP (x, i), XEXP (y, i), validate, equal_values))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 'E':
|
||
if (XVECLEN (x, i) != XVECLEN (y, i))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
if (! exp_equiv_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j), XVECEXP (y, i, j),
|
||
validate, equal_values))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 's':
|
||
if (strcmp (XSTR (x, i), XSTR (y, i)))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 'i':
|
||
if (XINT (x, i) != XINT (y, i))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 'w':
|
||
if (XWINT (x, i) != XWINT (y, i))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case '0':
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 iff any subexpression of X matches Y.
|
||
Here we do not require that X or Y be valid (for registers referred to)
|
||
for being in the hash table. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
refers_to_p (x, y)
|
||
rtx x, y;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
|
||
repeat:
|
||
if (x == y)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
if (x == 0 || y == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
/* If X as a whole has the same code as Y, they may match.
|
||
If so, return 1. */
|
||
if (code == GET_CODE (y))
|
||
{
|
||
if (exp_equiv_p (x, y, 0, 1))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* X does not match, so try its subexpressions. */
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
{
|
||
if (i == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
goto repeat;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
if (refers_to_p (XEXP (x, i), y))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
{
|
||
int j;
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
if (refers_to_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j), y))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given ADDR and SIZE (a memory address, and the size of the memory reference),
|
||
set PBASE, PSTART, and PEND which correspond to the base of the address,
|
||
the starting offset, and ending offset respectively.
|
||
|
||
ADDR is known to be a nonvarying address. */
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Despite what the comments say, this function is in fact frequently
|
||
passed varying addresses. This does not appear to cause any problems. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
set_nonvarying_address_components (addr, size, pbase, pstart, pend)
|
||
rtx addr;
|
||
int size;
|
||
rtx *pbase;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *pstart, *pend;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx base;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT start, end;
|
||
|
||
base = addr;
|
||
start = 0;
|
||
end = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Registers with nonvarying addresses usually have constant equivalents;
|
||
but the frame pointer register is also possible. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (base) == REG
|
||
&& qty_const != 0
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (base))
|
||
&& qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (base)]] == GET_MODE (base)
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (base)]] != 0)
|
||
base = qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (base)]];
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& qty_const != 0
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (XEXP (base, 0)))
|
||
&& (qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (base, 0))]]
|
||
== GET_MODE (XEXP (base, 0)))
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (base, 0))]])
|
||
{
|
||
start = INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
|
||
base = qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (base, 0))]];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle everything that we can find inside an address that has been
|
||
viewed as constant. */
|
||
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If no part of this switch does a "continue", the code outside
|
||
will exit this loop. */
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (base))
|
||
{
|
||
case LO_SUM:
|
||
/* By definition, operand1 of a LO_SUM is the associated constant
|
||
address. Use the associated constant address as the base
|
||
instead. */
|
||
base = XEXP (base, 1);
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
/* Strip off CONST. */
|
||
base = XEXP (base, 0);
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
start += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
|
||
base = XEXP (base, 0);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case AND:
|
||
/* Handle the case of an AND which is the negative of a power of
|
||
two. This is used to represent unaligned memory operations. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& exact_log2 (- INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1))) > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
set_nonvarying_address_components (XEXP (base, 0), size,
|
||
pbase, pstart, pend);
|
||
|
||
/* Assume the worst misalignment. START is affected, but not
|
||
END, so compensate but adjusting SIZE. Don't lose any
|
||
constant we already had. */
|
||
|
||
size = *pend - *pstart - INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)) - 1;
|
||
start += *pstart - INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)) - 1;
|
||
base = *pbase;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (base) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
start += INTVAL (base);
|
||
base = const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
end = start + size;
|
||
|
||
/* Set the return values. */
|
||
*pbase = base;
|
||
*pstart = start;
|
||
*pend = end;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 iff any subexpression of X refers to memory
|
||
at an address of BASE plus some offset
|
||
such that any of the bytes' offsets fall between START (inclusive)
|
||
and END (exclusive).
|
||
|
||
The value is undefined if X is a varying address (as determined by
|
||
cse_rtx_addr_varies_p). This function is not used in such cases.
|
||
|
||
When used in the cse pass, `qty_const' is nonzero, and it is used
|
||
to treat an address that is a register with a known constant value
|
||
as if it were that constant value.
|
||
In the loop pass, `qty_const' is zero, so this is not done. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
refers_to_mem_p (x, base, start, end)
|
||
rtx x, base;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT start, end;
|
||
{
|
||
register HOST_WIDE_INT i;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
|
||
repeat:
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
if (code == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx addr = XEXP (x, 0); /* Get the address. */
|
||
rtx mybase;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT mystart, myend;
|
||
|
||
set_nonvarying_address_components (addr, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)),
|
||
&mybase, &mystart, &myend);
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* refers_to_mem_p is never called with varying addresses.
|
||
If the base addresses are not equal, there is no chance
|
||
of the memory addresses conflicting. */
|
||
if (! rtx_equal_p (mybase, base))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return myend > start && mystart < end;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* X does not match, so try its subexpressions. */
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
{
|
||
if (i == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
goto repeat;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
if (refers_to_mem_p (XEXP (x, i), base, start, end))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
{
|
||
int j;
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
if (refers_to_mem_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j), base, start, end))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if X refers to memory at a varying address;
|
||
except that a register which has at the moment a known constant value
|
||
isn't considered variable. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (x)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
/* We need not check for X and the equivalence class being of the same
|
||
mode because if X is equivalent to a constant in some mode, it
|
||
doesn't vary in any mode. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
||
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (x, 0))]]
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (x, 0))]] != 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))
|
||
&& (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
|
||
== qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))]])
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))]])
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return rtx_addr_varies_p (x);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Canonicalize an expression:
|
||
replace each register reference inside it
|
||
with the "oldest" equivalent register.
|
||
|
||
If INSN is non-zero and we are replacing a pseudo with a hard register
|
||
or vice versa, validate_change is used to ensure that INSN remains valid
|
||
after we make our substitution. The calls are made with IN_GROUP non-zero
|
||
so apply_change_group must be called upon the outermost return from this
|
||
function (unless INSN is zero). The result of apply_change_group can
|
||
generally be discarded since the changes we are making are optional. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
canon_reg (x, insn)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PC:
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case ADDR_VEC:
|
||
case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
case REG:
|
||
{
|
||
register int first;
|
||
|
||
/* Never replace a hard reg, because hard regs can appear
|
||
in more than one machine mode, and we must preserve the mode
|
||
of each occurrence. Also, some hard regs appear in
|
||
MEMs that are shared and mustn't be altered. Don't try to
|
||
replace any reg that maps to a reg of class NO_REGS. */
|
||
if (REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
|| ! REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (x)))
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
first = qty_first_reg[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]];
|
||
return (first >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? regno_reg_rtx[first]
|
||
: REGNO_REG_CLASS (first) == NO_REGS ? x
|
||
: gen_rtx (REG, qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]], first));
|
||
}
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
register int j;
|
||
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new = canon_reg (XEXP (x, i), insn);
|
||
|
||
/* If replacing pseudo with hard reg or vice versa, ensure the
|
||
insn remains valid. Likewise if the insn has MATCH_DUPs. */
|
||
if (insn != 0 && new != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (new) == REG && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, i)) == REG
|
||
&& (((REGNO (new) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
!= (REGNO (XEXP (x, i)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
|
||
|| insn_n_dups[recog_memoized (insn)] > 0))
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, i), new, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
XEXP (x, i) = new;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
||
XVECEXP (x, i, j) = canon_reg (XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* LOC is a location with INSN that is an operand address (the contents of
|
||
a MEM). Find the best equivalent address to use that is valid for this
|
||
insn.
|
||
|
||
On most CISC machines, complicated address modes are costly, and rtx_cost
|
||
is a good approximation for that cost. However, most RISC machines have
|
||
only a few (usually only one) memory reference formats. If an address is
|
||
valid at all, it is often just as cheap as any other address. Hence, for
|
||
RISC machines, we use the configuration macro `ADDRESS_COST' to compare the
|
||
costs of various addresses. For two addresses of equal cost, choose the one
|
||
with the highest `rtx_cost' value as that has the potential of eliminating
|
||
the most insns. For equal costs, we choose the first in the equivalence
|
||
class. Note that we ignore the fact that pseudo registers are cheaper
|
||
than hard registers here because we would also prefer the pseudo registers.
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
find_best_addr (insn, loc)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
rtx *loc;
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *elt, *p;
|
||
rtx addr = *loc;
|
||
int our_cost;
|
||
int found_better = 1;
|
||
int save_do_not_record = do_not_record;
|
||
int save_hash_arg_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
int save_hash_arg_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
int addr_volatile;
|
||
int regno;
|
||
unsigned hash;
|
||
|
||
/* Do not try to replace constant addresses or addresses of local and
|
||
argument slots. These MEM expressions are made only once and inserted
|
||
in many instructions, as well as being used to control symbol table
|
||
output. It is not safe to clobber them.
|
||
|
||
There are some uncommon cases where the address is already in a register
|
||
for some reason, but we cannot take advantage of that because we have
|
||
no easy way to unshare the MEM. In addition, looking up all stack
|
||
addresses is costly. */
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (regno = REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)),
|
||
regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM || regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM))
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (addr) == REG
|
||
&& (regno = REGNO (addr), regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM))
|
||
|| CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (addr))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If this address is not simply a register, try to fold it. This will
|
||
sometimes simplify the expression. Many simplifications
|
||
will not be valid, but some, usually applying the associative rule, will
|
||
be valid and produce better code. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (addr) != REG
|
||
&& validate_change (insn, loc, fold_rtx (addr, insn), 0))
|
||
addr = *loc;
|
||
|
||
/* If this address is not in the hash table, we can't look for equivalences
|
||
of the whole address. Also, ignore if volatile. */
|
||
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash = HASH (addr, Pmode);
|
||
addr_volatile = do_not_record;
|
||
do_not_record = save_do_not_record;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = save_hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = save_hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
if (addr_volatile)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
elt = lookup (addr, hash, Pmode);
|
||
|
||
#ifndef ADDRESS_COST
|
||
if (elt)
|
||
{
|
||
our_cost = elt->cost;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the lowest cost below ours that works. */
|
||
for (elt = elt->first_same_value; elt; elt = elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (elt->cost < our_cost
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (elt->exp) == REG
|
||
|| exp_equiv_p (elt->exp, elt->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
&& validate_change (insn, loc,
|
||
canon_reg (copy_rtx (elt->exp), NULL_RTX), 0))
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
#else
|
||
|
||
if (elt)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We need to find the best (under the criteria documented above) entry
|
||
in the class that is valid. We use the `flag' field to indicate
|
||
choices that were invalid and iterate until we can't find a better
|
||
one that hasn't already been tried. */
|
||
|
||
for (p = elt->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
p->flag = 0;
|
||
|
||
while (found_better)
|
||
{
|
||
int best_addr_cost = ADDRESS_COST (*loc);
|
||
int best_rtx_cost = (elt->cost + 1) >> 1;
|
||
struct table_elt *best_elt = elt;
|
||
|
||
found_better = 0;
|
||
for (p = elt->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
if (! p->flag
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (p->exp) == REG
|
||
|| exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
&& (ADDRESS_COST (p->exp) < best_addr_cost
|
||
|| (ADDRESS_COST (p->exp) == best_addr_cost
|
||
&& (p->cost + 1) >> 1 > best_rtx_cost)))
|
||
{
|
||
found_better = 1;
|
||
best_addr_cost = ADDRESS_COST (p->exp);
|
||
best_rtx_cost = (p->cost + 1) >> 1;
|
||
best_elt = p;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (found_better)
|
||
{
|
||
if (validate_change (insn, loc,
|
||
canon_reg (copy_rtx (best_elt->exp),
|
||
NULL_RTX), 0))
|
||
return;
|
||
else
|
||
best_elt->flag = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the address is a binary operation with the first operand a register
|
||
and the second a constant, do the same as above, but looking for
|
||
equivalences of the register. Then try to simplify before checking for
|
||
the best address to use. This catches a few cases: First is when we
|
||
have REG+const and the register is another REG+const. We can often merge
|
||
the constants and eliminate one insn and one register. It may also be
|
||
that a machine has a cheap REG+REG+const. Finally, this improves the
|
||
code on the Alpha for unaligned byte stores. */
|
||
|
||
if (flag_expensive_optimizations
|
||
&& (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (*loc)) == '2'
|
||
|| GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (*loc)) == 'c')
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (*loc, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (*loc, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx c = XEXP (*loc, 1);
|
||
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash = HASH (XEXP (*loc, 0), Pmode);
|
||
do_not_record = save_do_not_record;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = save_hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = save_hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
elt = lookup (XEXP (*loc, 0), hash, Pmode);
|
||
if (elt == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* We need to find the best (under the criteria documented above) entry
|
||
in the class that is valid. We use the `flag' field to indicate
|
||
choices that were invalid and iterate until we can't find a better
|
||
one that hasn't already been tried. */
|
||
|
||
for (p = elt->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
p->flag = 0;
|
||
|
||
while (found_better)
|
||
{
|
||
int best_addr_cost = ADDRESS_COST (*loc);
|
||
int best_rtx_cost = (COST (*loc) + 1) >> 1;
|
||
struct table_elt *best_elt = elt;
|
||
rtx best_rtx = *loc;
|
||
int count;
|
||
|
||
/* This is at worst case an O(n^2) algorithm, so limit our search
|
||
to the first 32 elements on the list. This avoids trouble
|
||
compiling code with very long basic blocks that can easily
|
||
call cse_gen_binary so many times that we run out of memory. */
|
||
|
||
found_better = 0;
|
||
for (p = elt->first_same_value, count = 0;
|
||
p && count < 32;
|
||
p = p->next_same_value, count++)
|
||
if (! p->flag
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (p->exp) == REG
|
||
|| exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new = cse_gen_binary (GET_CODE (*loc), Pmode, p->exp, c);
|
||
|
||
if ((ADDRESS_COST (new) < best_addr_cost
|
||
|| (ADDRESS_COST (new) == best_addr_cost
|
||
&& (COST (new) + 1) >> 1 > best_rtx_cost)))
|
||
{
|
||
found_better = 1;
|
||
best_addr_cost = ADDRESS_COST (new);
|
||
best_rtx_cost = (COST (new) + 1) >> 1;
|
||
best_elt = p;
|
||
best_rtx = new;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (found_better)
|
||
{
|
||
if (validate_change (insn, loc,
|
||
canon_reg (copy_rtx (best_rtx),
|
||
NULL_RTX), 0))
|
||
return;
|
||
else
|
||
best_elt->flag = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given an operation (CODE, *PARG1, *PARG2), where code is a comparison
|
||
operation (EQ, NE, GT, etc.), follow it back through the hash table and
|
||
what values are being compared.
|
||
|
||
*PARG1 and *PARG2 are updated to contain the rtx representing the values
|
||
actually being compared. For example, if *PARG1 was (cc0) and *PARG2
|
||
was (const_int 0), *PARG1 and *PARG2 will be set to the objects that were
|
||
compared to produce cc0.
|
||
|
||
The return value is the comparison operator and is either the code of
|
||
A or the code corresponding to the inverse of the comparison. */
|
||
|
||
static enum rtx_code
|
||
find_comparison_args (code, parg1, parg2, pmode1, pmode2)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
rtx *parg1, *parg2;
|
||
enum machine_mode *pmode1, *pmode2;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx arg1, arg2;
|
||
|
||
arg1 = *parg1, arg2 = *parg2;
|
||
|
||
/* If ARG2 is const0_rtx, see what ARG1 is equivalent to. */
|
||
|
||
while (arg2 == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (arg1)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set non-zero when we find something of interest. */
|
||
rtx x = 0;
|
||
int reverse_code = 0;
|
||
struct table_elt *p = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If arg1 is a COMPARE, extract the comparison arguments from it.
|
||
On machines with CC0, this is the only case that can occur, since
|
||
fold_rtx will return the COMPARE or item being compared with zero
|
||
when given CC0. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (arg1) == COMPARE && arg2 == const0_rtx)
|
||
x = arg1;
|
||
|
||
/* If ARG1 is a comparison operator and CODE is testing for
|
||
STORE_FLAG_VALUE, get the inner arguments. */
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (arg1)) == '<')
|
||
{
|
||
if (code == NE
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (arg1)) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& code == LT && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (arg1)) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE < 0)
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
x = arg1;
|
||
else if (code == EQ
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (arg1)) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& code == GE && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (arg1)) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE < 0)
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
x = arg1, reverse_code = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* ??? We could also check for
|
||
|
||
(ne (and (eq (...) (const_int 1))) (const_int 0))
|
||
|
||
and related forms, but let's wait until we see them occurring. */
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
/* Look up ARG1 in the hash table and see if it has an equivalence
|
||
that lets us see what is being compared. */
|
||
p = lookup (arg1, safe_hash (arg1, GET_MODE (arg1)) % NBUCKETS,
|
||
GET_MODE (arg1));
|
||
if (p) p = p->first_same_value;
|
||
|
||
for (; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (p->exp);
|
||
|
||
/* If the entry isn't valid, skip it. */
|
||
if (! exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == COMPARE
|
||
/* Another possibility is that this machine has a compare insn
|
||
that includes the comparison code. In that case, ARG1 would
|
||
be equivalent to a comparison operation that would set ARG1 to
|
||
either STORE_FLAG_VALUE or zero. If this is an NE operation,
|
||
ORIG_CODE is the actual comparison being done; if it is an EQ,
|
||
we must reverse ORIG_CODE. On machine with a negative value
|
||
for STORE_FLAG_VALUE, also look at LT and GE operations. */
|
||
|| ((code == NE
|
||
|| (code == LT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (inner_mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode)
|
||
<= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
&& (STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
|
||
<< (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - 1))))
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
|| (code == LT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (inner_mode) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE < 0)
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
&& GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p->exp)) == '<'))
|
||
{
|
||
x = p->exp;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((code == EQ
|
||
|| (code == GE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (inner_mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode)
|
||
<= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
&& (STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
|
||
<< (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - 1))))
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
|| (code == GE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (inner_mode) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE < 0)
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
&& GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p->exp)) == '<')
|
||
{
|
||
reverse_code = 1;
|
||
x = p->exp;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is fp + constant, the equivalent is a better operand since
|
||
it may let us predict the value of the comparison. */
|
||
else if (NONZERO_BASE_PLUS_P (p->exp))
|
||
{
|
||
arg1 = p->exp;
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we didn't find a useful equivalence for ARG1, we are done.
|
||
Otherwise, set up for the next iteration. */
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
arg1 = XEXP (x, 0), arg2 = XEXP (x, 1);
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x)) == '<')
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
|
||
if (reverse_code)
|
||
code = reverse_condition (code);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return our results. Return the modes from before fold_rtx
|
||
because fold_rtx might produce const_int, and then it's too late. */
|
||
*pmode1 = GET_MODE (arg1), *pmode2 = GET_MODE (arg2);
|
||
*parg1 = fold_rtx (arg1, 0), *parg2 = fold_rtx (arg2, 0);
|
||
|
||
return code;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Try to simplify a unary operation CODE whose output mode is to be
|
||
MODE with input operand OP whose mode was originally OP_MODE.
|
||
Return zero if no simplification can be made. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
simplify_unary_operation (code, mode, op, op_mode)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op;
|
||
enum machine_mode op_mode;
|
||
{
|
||
register int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* The order of these tests is critical so that, for example, we don't
|
||
check the wrong mode (input vs. output) for a conversion operation,
|
||
such as FIX. At some point, this should be simplified. */
|
||
|
||
#if !defined(REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE) || defined(REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
|
||
if (code == FLOAT && GET_MODE (op) == VOIDmode
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT hv, lv;
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
|
||
lv = INTVAL (op), hv = INTVAL (op) < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op), hv = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef REAL_ARITHMETIC
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (d, lv, hv);
|
||
#else
|
||
if (hv < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
d = (double) (~ hv);
|
||
d *= ((double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2))
|
||
* (double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2)));
|
||
d += (double) (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (~ lv);
|
||
d = (- d - 1.0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
d = (double) hv;
|
||
d *= ((double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2))
|
||
* (double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2)));
|
||
d += (double) (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) lv;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* REAL_ARITHMETIC */
|
||
|
||
return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (d, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT && GET_MODE (op) == VOIDmode
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT hv, lv;
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
|
||
lv = INTVAL (op), hv = INTVAL (op) < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op), hv = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT * 2)
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
hv = 0, lv &= GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef REAL_ARITHMETIC
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_UNSIGNED_INT (d, lv, hv);
|
||
#else
|
||
|
||
d = (double) (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) hv;
|
||
d *= ((double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2))
|
||
* (double) ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2)));
|
||
d += (double) (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) lv;
|
||
#endif /* REAL_ARITHMETIC */
|
||
|
||
return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (d, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT && width > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
register HOST_WIDE_INT arg0 = INTVAL (op);
|
||
register HOST_WIDE_INT val;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case NOT:
|
||
val = ~ arg0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
val = - arg0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ABS:
|
||
val = (arg0 >= 0 ? arg0 : - arg0);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FFS:
|
||
/* Don't use ffs here. Instead, get low order bit and then its
|
||
number. If arg0 is zero, this will return 0, as desired. */
|
||
arg0 &= GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
|
||
val = exact_log2 (arg0 & (- arg0)) + 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TRUNCATE:
|
||
val = arg0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ZERO_EXTEND:
|
||
if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
op_mode = mode;
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we were really extending the mode,
|
||
we would have to distinguish between zero-extension
|
||
and sign-extension. */
|
||
if (width != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
val = arg0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
val = arg0 & ~((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode));
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SIGN_EXTEND:
|
||
if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
op_mode = mode;
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we were really extending the mode,
|
||
we would have to distinguish between zero-extension
|
||
and sign-extension. */
|
||
if (width != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
val = arg0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
val
|
||
= arg0 & ~((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode));
|
||
if (val
|
||
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) - 1)))
|
||
val -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SQRT:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the bits that don't belong in our mode,
|
||
unless they and our sign bit are all one.
|
||
So we get either a reasonable negative value or a reasonable
|
||
unsigned value for this mode. */
|
||
if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& ((val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1)))
|
||
!= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1))))
|
||
val &= (1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
return GEN_INT (val);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We can do some operations on integer CONST_DOUBLEs. Also allow
|
||
for a DImode operation on a CONST_INT. */
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (op) == VOIDmode && width <= HOST_BITS_PER_INT * 2
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT l1, h1, lv, hv;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
||
l1 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op), h1 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op);
|
||
else
|
||
l1 = INTVAL (op), h1 = l1 < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case NOT:
|
||
lv = ~ l1;
|
||
hv = ~ h1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
neg_double (l1, h1, &lv, &hv);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ABS:
|
||
if (h1 < 0)
|
||
neg_double (l1, h1, &lv, &hv);
|
||
else
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FFS:
|
||
hv = 0;
|
||
if (l1 == 0)
|
||
lv = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT + exact_log2 (h1 & (-h1)) + 1;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = exact_log2 (l1 & (-l1)) + 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TRUNCATE:
|
||
/* This is just a change-of-mode, so do nothing. */
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ZERO_EXTEND:
|
||
if (op_mode == VOIDmode
|
||
|| GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
hv = 0;
|
||
lv = l1 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SIGN_EXTEND:
|
||
if (op_mode == VOIDmode
|
||
|| GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
lv = l1 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& (lv & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
|
||
<< (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) - 1))) != 0)
|
||
lv -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode);
|
||
|
||
hv = (lv < 0) ? ~ (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0 : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SQRT:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return immed_double_const (lv, hv, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if ! defined (REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE) || defined (REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
jmp_buf handler;
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
|
||
if (setjmp (handler))
|
||
/* There used to be a warning here, but that is inadvisable.
|
||
People may want to cause traps, and the natural way
|
||
to do it should not get a warning. */
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (handler);
|
||
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op);
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
d = REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ABS:
|
||
if (REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (d))
|
||
d = REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
|
||
d = real_value_truncate (mode, d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FLOAT_EXTEND:
|
||
/* All this does is change the mode. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FIX:
|
||
d = REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UNSIGNED_FIX:
|
||
d = REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SQRT:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
x = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (d, mode);
|
||
set_float_handler (NULL_PTR);
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op)) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT && width > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
jmp_buf handler;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val;
|
||
|
||
if (setjmp (handler))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (handler);
|
||
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op);
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case FIX:
|
||
val = REAL_VALUE_FIX (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UNSIGNED_FIX:
|
||
val = REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (d);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (NULL_PTR);
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the bits that don't belong in our mode,
|
||
unless they and our sign bit are all one.
|
||
So we get either a reasonable negative value or a reasonable
|
||
unsigned value for this mode. */
|
||
if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& ((val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1)))
|
||
!= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1))))
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
return GEN_INT (val);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
/* This was formerly used only for non-IEEE float.
|
||
eggert@twinsun.com says it is safe for IEEE also. */
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* There are some simplifications we can do even if the operands
|
||
aren't constant. */
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
case NOT:
|
||
/* (not (not X)) == X, similarly for NEG. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == code)
|
||
return XEXP (op, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SIGN_EXTEND:
|
||
/* (sign_extend (truncate (minus (label_ref L1) (label_ref L2))))
|
||
becomes just the MINUS if its mode is MODE. This allows
|
||
folding switch statements on machines using casesi (such as
|
||
the Vax). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) == TRUNCATE
|
||
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == mode
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == MINUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
return XEXP (op, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Simplify a binary operation CODE with result mode MODE, operating on OP0
|
||
and OP1. Return 0 if no simplification is possible.
|
||
|
||
Don't use this for relational operations such as EQ or LT.
|
||
Use simplify_relational_operation instead. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
simplify_binary_operation (code, mode, op0, op1)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
{
|
||
register HOST_WIDE_INT arg0, arg1, arg0s, arg1s;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val;
|
||
int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
|
||
/* Relational operations don't work here. We must know the mode
|
||
of the operands in order to do the comparison correctly.
|
||
Assuming a full word can give incorrect results.
|
||
Consider comparing 128 with -128 in QImode. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == '<')
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
#if ! defined (REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE) || defined (REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& mode == GET_MODE (op0) && mode == GET_MODE (op1))
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE f0, f1, value;
|
||
jmp_buf handler;
|
||
|
||
if (setjmp (handler))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (handler);
|
||
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (f0, op0);
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (f1, op1);
|
||
f0 = real_value_truncate (mode, f0);
|
||
f1 = real_value_truncate (mode, f1);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef REAL_ARITHMETIC
|
||
REAL_ARITHMETIC (value, rtx_to_tree_code (code), f0, f1);
|
||
#else
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
value = f0 + f1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
value = f0 - f1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
value = f0 * f1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DIV:
|
||
#ifndef REAL_INFINITY
|
||
if (f1 == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
value = f0 / f1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SMIN:
|
||
value = MIN (f0, f1);
|
||
break;
|
||
case SMAX:
|
||
value = MAX (f0, f1);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
value = real_value_truncate (mode, value);
|
||
set_float_handler (NULL_PTR);
|
||
return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (value, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* not REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE, or REAL_ARITHMETIC */
|
||
|
||
/* We can fold some multi-word operations. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& width == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT * 2
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT l1, l2, h1, h2, lv, hv;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
||
l1 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op0), h1 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op0);
|
||
else
|
||
l1 = INTVAL (op0), h1 = l1 < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
||
l2 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op1), h2 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op1);
|
||
else
|
||
l2 = INTVAL (op1), h2 = l2 < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
/* A - B == A + (-B). */
|
||
neg_double (l2, h2, &lv, &hv);
|
||
l2 = lv, h2 = hv;
|
||
|
||
/* .. fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
add_double (l1, h1, l2, h2, &lv, &hv);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
mul_double (l1, h1, l2, h2, &lv, &hv);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DIV: case MOD: case UDIV: case UMOD:
|
||
/* We'd need to include tree.h to do this and it doesn't seem worth
|
||
it. */
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case AND:
|
||
lv = l1 & l2, hv = h1 & h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IOR:
|
||
lv = l1 | l2, hv = h1 | h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case XOR:
|
||
lv = l1 ^ l2, hv = h1 ^ h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SMIN:
|
||
if (h1 < h2
|
||
|| (h1 == h2
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l1
|
||
< (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l2)))
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = l2, hv = h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SMAX:
|
||
if (h1 > h2
|
||
|| (h1 == h2
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l1
|
||
> (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l2)))
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = l2, hv = h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMIN:
|
||
if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) h1 < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) h2
|
||
|| (h1 == h2
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l1
|
||
< (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l2)))
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = l2, hv = h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMAX:
|
||
if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) h1 > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) h2
|
||
|| (h1 == h2
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l1
|
||
> (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) l2)))
|
||
lv = l1, hv = h1;
|
||
else
|
||
lv = l2, hv = h2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFTRT:
|
||
case ASHIFT:
|
||
case ROTATE: case ROTATERT:
|
||
#ifdef SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
||
if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED)
|
||
l2 &= (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1), h2 = 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (h2 != 0 || l2 < 0 || l2 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (code == LSHIFTRT || code == ASHIFTRT)
|
||
rshift_double (l1, h1, l2, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), &lv, &hv,
|
||
code == ASHIFTRT);
|
||
else if (code == ASHIFT)
|
||
lshift_double (l1, h1, l2, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), &lv, &hv, 1);
|
||
else if (code == ROTATE)
|
||
lrotate_double (l1, h1, l2, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), &lv, &hv);
|
||
else /* code == ROTATERT */
|
||
rrotate_double (l1, h1, l2, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), &lv, &hv);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return immed_double_const (lv, hv, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) != CONST_INT || GET_CODE (op1) != CONST_INT
|
||
|| width > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || width == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Even if we can't compute a constant result,
|
||
there are some cases worth simplifying. */
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
/* In IEEE floating point, x+0 is not the same as x. Similarly
|
||
for the other optimizations below. */
|
||
if (TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT == IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) && ! flag_fast_math)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (op1 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
/* ((-a) + b) -> (b - a) and similarly for (a + (-b)) */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == NEG)
|
||
return cse_gen_binary (MINUS, mode, op1, XEXP (op0, 0));
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (op1) == NEG)
|
||
return cse_gen_binary (MINUS, mode, op0, XEXP (op1, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* Handle both-operands-constant cases. We can only add
|
||
CONST_INTs to constants since the sum of relocatable symbols
|
||
can't be handled by most assemblers. Don't add CONST_INT
|
||
to CONST_INT since overflow won't be computed properly if wider
|
||
than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT. */
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && GET_MODE (op0) != VOIDmode
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (op1));
|
||
else if (CONSTANT_P (op1) && GET_MODE (op1) != VOIDmode
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (op0));
|
||
|
||
/* See if this is something like X * C - X or vice versa or
|
||
if the multiplication is written as a shift. If so, we can
|
||
distribute and make a new multiply, shift, or maybe just
|
||
have X (if C is 2 in the example above). But don't make
|
||
real multiply if we didn't have one before. */
|
||
|
||
if (! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT coeff0 = 1, coeff1 = 1;
|
||
rtx lhs = op0, rhs = op1;
|
||
int had_mult = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (lhs) == NEG)
|
||
coeff0 = -1, lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (lhs) == MULT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff0 = INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
had_mult = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (lhs) == ASHIFT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)) >= 0
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff0 = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1));
|
||
lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (rhs) == NEG)
|
||
coeff1 = -1, rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (rhs) == MULT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff1 = INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
had_mult = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (rhs) == ASHIFT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)) >= 0
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff1 = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1));
|
||
rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (lhs, rhs))
|
||
{
|
||
tem = cse_gen_binary (MULT, mode, lhs,
|
||
GEN_INT (coeff0 + coeff1));
|
||
return (GET_CODE (tem) == MULT && ! had_mult) ? 0 : tem;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If one of the operands is a PLUS or a MINUS, see if we can
|
||
simplify this by the associative law.
|
||
Don't use the associative law for floating point.
|
||
The inaccuracy makes it nonassociative,
|
||
and subtle programs can break if operations are associated. */
|
||
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op0) == PLUS || GET_CODE (op0) == MINUS
|
||
|| GET_CODE (op1) == PLUS || GET_CODE (op1) == MINUS)
|
||
&& (tem = simplify_plus_minus (code, mode, op0, op1)) != 0)
|
||
return tem;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case COMPARE:
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
/* Convert (compare FOO (const_int 0)) to FOO unless we aren't
|
||
using cc0, in which case we want to leave it as a COMPARE
|
||
so we can distinguish it from a register-register-copy.
|
||
|
||
In IEEE floating point, x-0 is not the same as x. */
|
||
|
||
if ((TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT != IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
|| ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || flag_fast_math)
|
||
&& op1 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
#else
|
||
/* Do nothing here. */
|
||
#endif
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
/* None of these optimizations can be done for IEEE
|
||
floating point. */
|
||
if (TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT == IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
&& FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) && ! flag_fast_math)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* We can't assume x-x is 0 even with non-IEEE floating point,
|
||
but since it is zero except in very strange circumstances, we
|
||
will treat it as zero with -ffast-math. */
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0)
|
||
&& (! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || flag_fast_math))
|
||
return CONST0_RTX (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* Change subtraction from zero into negation. */
|
||
if (op0 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
||
return gen_rtx (NEG, mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
/* (-1 - a) is ~a. */
|
||
if (op0 == constm1_rtx)
|
||
return gen_rtx (NOT, mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
/* Subtracting 0 has no effect. */
|
||
if (op1 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
/* See if this is something like X * C - X or vice versa or
|
||
if the multiplication is written as a shift. If so, we can
|
||
distribute and make a new multiply, shift, or maybe just
|
||
have X (if C is 2 in the example above). But don't make
|
||
real multiply if we didn't have one before. */
|
||
|
||
if (! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT coeff0 = 1, coeff1 = 1;
|
||
rtx lhs = op0, rhs = op1;
|
||
int had_mult = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (lhs) == NEG)
|
||
coeff0 = -1, lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (lhs) == MULT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff0 = INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
had_mult = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (lhs) == ASHIFT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)) >= 0
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff0 = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1));
|
||
lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (rhs) == NEG)
|
||
coeff1 = - 1, rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (rhs) == MULT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff1 = INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
had_mult = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (rhs) == ASHIFT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)) >= 0
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
coeff1 = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1));
|
||
rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (lhs, rhs))
|
||
{
|
||
tem = cse_gen_binary (MULT, mode, lhs,
|
||
GEN_INT (coeff0 - coeff1));
|
||
return (GET_CODE (tem) == MULT && ! had_mult) ? 0 : tem;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* (a - (-b)) -> (a + b). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == NEG)
|
||
return cse_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, XEXP (op1, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* If one of the operands is a PLUS or a MINUS, see if we can
|
||
simplify this by the associative law.
|
||
Don't use the associative law for floating point.
|
||
The inaccuracy makes it nonassociative,
|
||
and subtle programs can break if operations are associated. */
|
||
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op0) == PLUS || GET_CODE (op0) == MINUS
|
||
|| GET_CODE (op1) == PLUS || GET_CODE (op1) == MINUS)
|
||
&& (tem = simplify_plus_minus (code, mode, op0, op1)) != 0)
|
||
return tem;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't let a relocatable value get a negative coeff. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT && GET_MODE (op0) != VOIDmode)
|
||
return plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
if (op1 == constm1_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
tem = simplify_unary_operation (NEG, mode, op0, mode);
|
||
|
||
return tem ? tem : gen_rtx (NEG, mode, op0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In IEEE floating point, x*0 is not always 0. */
|
||
if ((TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT != IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
|| ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || flag_fast_math)
|
||
&& op1 == CONST0_RTX (mode)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
|
||
/* In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans.
|
||
However, ANSI says we can drop signals,
|
||
so we can do this anyway. */
|
||
if (op1 == CONST1_RTX (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
/* Convert multiply by constant power of two into shift unless
|
||
we are still generating RTL. This test is a kludge. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (val = exact_log2 (INTVAL (op1))) >= 0
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_function_value_matters)
|
||
return gen_rtx (ASHIFT, mode, op0, GEN_INT (val));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op1)) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
jmp_buf handler;
|
||
int op1is2, op1ism1;
|
||
|
||
if (setjmp (handler))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (handler);
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op1);
|
||
op1is2 = REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d, dconst2);
|
||
op1ism1 = REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d, dconstm1);
|
||
set_float_handler (NULL_PTR);
|
||
|
||
/* x*2 is x+x and x*(-1) is -x */
|
||
if (op1is2 && GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
|
||
return gen_rtx (PLUS, mode, op0, copy_rtx (op0));
|
||
|
||
else if (op1ism1 && GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
|
||
return gen_rtx (NEG, mode, op0);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IOR:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1) && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
/* A | (~A) -> -1 */
|
||
if (((GET_CODE (op0) == NOT && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (op0, 0), op1))
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (op1) == NOT && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (op1, 0), op0)))
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
|
||
return constm1_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case XOR:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
|
||
return gen_rtx (NOT, mode, op0);
|
||
if (op0 == op1 && ! side_effects_p (op0)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case AND:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
if (op0 == op1 && ! side_effects_p (op0)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
/* A & (~A) -> 0 */
|
||
if (((GET_CODE (op0) == NOT && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (op0, 0), op1))
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (op1) == NOT && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (op1, 0), op0)))
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UDIV:
|
||
/* Convert divide by power of two into shift (divide by 1 handled
|
||
below). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (arg1 = exact_log2 (INTVAL (op1))) > 0)
|
||
return gen_rtx (LSHIFTRT, mode, op0, GEN_INT (arg1));
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case DIV:
|
||
if (op1 == CONST1_RTX (mode))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
/* In IEEE floating point, 0/x is not always 0. */
|
||
if ((TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT != IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
|| ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || flag_fast_math)
|
||
&& op0 == CONST0_RTX (mode)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op1))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
#if ! defined (REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE) || defined (REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
/* Change division by a constant into multiplication. Only do
|
||
this with -ffast-math until an expert says it is safe in
|
||
general. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op1)) == MODE_FLOAT
|
||
&& op1 != CONST0_RTX (mode)
|
||
&& flag_fast_math)
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op1);
|
||
|
||
if (! REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d, dconst0))
|
||
{
|
||
#if defined (REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
REAL_ARITHMETIC (d, rtx_to_tree_code (DIV), dconst1, d);
|
||
return gen_rtx (MULT, mode, op0,
|
||
CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (d, mode));
|
||
#else
|
||
return gen_rtx (MULT, mode, op0,
|
||
CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (1./d, mode));
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMOD:
|
||
/* Handle modulus by power of two (mod with 1 handled below). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& exact_log2 (INTVAL (op1)) > 0)
|
||
return gen_rtx (AND, mode, op0, GEN_INT (INTVAL (op1) - 1));
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case MOD:
|
||
if ((op0 == const0_rtx || op1 == const1_rtx)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0) && ! side_effects_p (op1))
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ROTATERT:
|
||
case ROTATE:
|
||
/* Rotating ~0 always results in ~0. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT && width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op0) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op1))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case ASHIFT:
|
||
case ASHIFTRT:
|
||
case LSHIFTRT:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
if (op0 == const0_rtx && ! side_effects_p (op1))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SMIN:
|
||
if (width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op1) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width -1)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
else if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1) && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SMAX:
|
||
if (width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& (INTVAL (op1)
|
||
== (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
else if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1) && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMIN:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
else if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1) && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMAX:
|
||
if (op1 == constm1_rtx && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op1;
|
||
else if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1) && ! side_effects_p (op0))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Get the integer argument values in two forms:
|
||
zero-extended in ARG0, ARG1 and sign-extended in ARG0S, ARG1S. */
|
||
|
||
arg0 = INTVAL (op0);
|
||
arg1 = INTVAL (op1);
|
||
|
||
if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
arg0 &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
arg1 &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
arg0s = arg0;
|
||
if (arg0s & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1)))
|
||
arg0s |= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width);
|
||
|
||
arg1s = arg1;
|
||
if (arg1s & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1)))
|
||
arg1s |= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
arg0s = arg0;
|
||
arg1s = arg1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the value of the arithmetic. */
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
val = arg0s + arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
val = arg0s - arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
val = arg0s * arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DIV:
|
||
if (arg1s == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
val = arg0s / arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MOD:
|
||
if (arg1s == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
val = arg0s % arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UDIV:
|
||
if (arg1 == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
val = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0 / arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMOD:
|
||
if (arg1 == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
val = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0 % arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case AND:
|
||
val = arg0 & arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IOR:
|
||
val = arg0 | arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case XOR:
|
||
val = arg0 ^ arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LSHIFTRT:
|
||
/* If shift count is undefined, don't fold it; let the machine do
|
||
what it wants. But truncate it if the machine will do that. */
|
||
if (arg1 < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
||
if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED)
|
||
arg1 %= width;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
val = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) >> arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ASHIFT:
|
||
if (arg1 < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
||
if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED)
|
||
arg1 %= width;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
val = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) << arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ASHIFTRT:
|
||
if (arg1 < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
||
if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED)
|
||
arg1 %= width;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
val = arg0s >> arg1;
|
||
|
||
/* Bootstrap compiler may not have sign extended the right shift.
|
||
Manually extend the sign to insure bootstrap cc matches gcc. */
|
||
if (arg0s < 0 && arg1 > 0)
|
||
val |= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) -1) << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - arg1);
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ROTATERT:
|
||
if (arg1 < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
arg1 %= width;
|
||
val = ((((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) << (width - arg1))
|
||
| (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) >> arg1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ROTATE:
|
||
if (arg1 < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
arg1 %= width;
|
||
val = ((((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) << arg1)
|
||
| (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0) >> (width - arg1)));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case COMPARE:
|
||
/* Do nothing here. */
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case SMIN:
|
||
val = arg0s <= arg1s ? arg0s : arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMIN:
|
||
val = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0
|
||
<= (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg1 ? arg0 : arg1);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SMAX:
|
||
val = arg0s > arg1s ? arg0s : arg1s;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UMAX:
|
||
val = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg0
|
||
> (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) arg1 ? arg0 : arg1);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the bits that don't belong in our mode, unless they and our sign
|
||
bit are all one. So we get either a reasonable negative value or a
|
||
reasonable unsigned value for this mode. */
|
||
if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& ((val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1)))
|
||
!= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1))))
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
return GEN_INT (val);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Simplify a PLUS or MINUS, at least one of whose operands may be another
|
||
PLUS or MINUS.
|
||
|
||
Rather than test for specific case, we do this by a brute-force method
|
||
and do all possible simplifications until no more changes occur. Then
|
||
we rebuild the operation. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
simplify_plus_minus (code, mode, op0, op1)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ops[8];
|
||
int negs[8];
|
||
rtx result, tem;
|
||
int n_ops = 2, input_ops = 2, input_consts = 0, n_consts = 0;
|
||
int first = 1, negate = 0, changed;
|
||
int i, j;
|
||
|
||
bzero ((char *) ops, sizeof ops);
|
||
|
||
/* Set up the two operands and then expand them until nothing has been
|
||
changed. If we run out of room in our array, give up; this should
|
||
almost never happen. */
|
||
|
||
ops[0] = op0, ops[1] = op1, negs[0] = 0, negs[1] = (code == MINUS);
|
||
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
while (changed)
|
||
{
|
||
changed = 0;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_ops; i++)
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (ops[i]))
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
if (n_ops == 7)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
ops[n_ops] = XEXP (ops[i], 1);
|
||
negs[n_ops++] = GET_CODE (ops[i]) == MINUS ? !negs[i] : negs[i];
|
||
ops[i] = XEXP (ops[i], 0);
|
||
input_ops++;
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
ops[i] = XEXP (ops[i], 0);
|
||
negs[i] = ! negs[i];
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
ops[i] = XEXP (ops[i], 0);
|
||
input_consts++;
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NOT:
|
||
/* ~a -> (-a - 1) */
|
||
if (n_ops != 7)
|
||
{
|
||
ops[n_ops] = constm1_rtx;
|
||
negs[n_ops++] = negs[i];
|
||
ops[i] = XEXP (ops[i], 0);
|
||
negs[i] = ! negs[i];
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
if (negs[i])
|
||
ops[i] = GEN_INT (- INTVAL (ops[i])), negs[i] = 0, changed = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we only have two operands, we can't do anything. */
|
||
if (n_ops <= 2)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Now simplify each pair of operands until nothing changes. The first
|
||
time through just simplify constants against each other. */
|
||
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
while (changed)
|
||
{
|
||
changed = first;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_ops - 1; i++)
|
||
for (j = i + 1; j < n_ops; j++)
|
||
if (ops[i] != 0 && ops[j] != 0
|
||
&& (! first || (CONSTANT_P (ops[i]) && CONSTANT_P (ops[j]))))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx lhs = ops[i], rhs = ops[j];
|
||
enum rtx_code ncode = PLUS;
|
||
|
||
if (negs[i] && ! negs[j])
|
||
lhs = ops[j], rhs = ops[i], ncode = MINUS;
|
||
else if (! negs[i] && negs[j])
|
||
ncode = MINUS;
|
||
|
||
tem = simplify_binary_operation (ncode, mode, lhs, rhs);
|
||
if (tem)
|
||
{
|
||
ops[i] = tem, ops[j] = 0;
|
||
negs[i] = negs[i] && negs[j];
|
||
if (GET_CODE (tem) == NEG)
|
||
ops[i] = XEXP (tem, 0), negs[i] = ! negs[i];
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (ops[i]) == CONST_INT && negs[i])
|
||
ops[i] = GEN_INT (- INTVAL (ops[i])), negs[i] = 0;
|
||
changed = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
first = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pack all the operands to the lower-numbered entries and give up if
|
||
we didn't reduce the number of operands we had. Make sure we
|
||
count a CONST as two operands. If we have the same number of
|
||
operands, but have made more CONSTs than we had, this is also
|
||
an improvement, so accept it. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0, j = 0; j < n_ops; j++)
|
||
if (ops[j] != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
ops[i] = ops[j], negs[i++] = negs[j];
|
||
if (GET_CODE (ops[j]) == CONST)
|
||
n_consts++;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (i + n_consts > input_ops
|
||
|| (i + n_consts == input_ops && n_consts <= input_consts))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
n_ops = i;
|
||
|
||
/* If we have a CONST_INT, put it last. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_ops - 1; i++)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (ops[i]) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
tem = ops[n_ops - 1], ops[n_ops - 1] = ops[i] , ops[i] = tem;
|
||
j = negs[n_ops - 1], negs[n_ops - 1] = negs[i], negs[i] = j;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Put a non-negated operand first. If there aren't any, make all
|
||
operands positive and negate the whole thing later. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_ops && negs[i]; i++)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
if (i == n_ops)
|
||
{
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_ops; i++)
|
||
negs[i] = 0;
|
||
negate = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (i != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
tem = ops[0], ops[0] = ops[i], ops[i] = tem;
|
||
j = negs[0], negs[0] = negs[i], negs[i] = j;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now make the result by performing the requested operations. */
|
||
result = ops[0];
|
||
for (i = 1; i < n_ops; i++)
|
||
result = cse_gen_binary (negs[i] ? MINUS : PLUS, mode, result, ops[i]);
|
||
|
||
return negate ? gen_rtx (NEG, mode, result) : result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Make a binary operation by properly ordering the operands and
|
||
seeing if the expression folds. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
cse_gen_binary (code, mode, op0, op1)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
|
||
/* Put complex operands first and constants second if commutative. */
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'c'
|
||
&& ((CONSTANT_P (op0) && GET_CODE (op1) != CONST_INT)
|
||
|| (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (op0)) == 'o'
|
||
&& GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (op1)) != 'o')
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
|
||
&& GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op0))) == 'o'
|
||
&& GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (op1)) != 'o')))
|
||
tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
|
||
|
||
/* If this simplifies, do it. */
|
||
tem = simplify_binary_operation (code, mode, op0, op1);
|
||
|
||
if (tem)
|
||
return tem;
|
||
|
||
/* Handle addition and subtraction of CONST_INT specially. Otherwise,
|
||
just form the operation. */
|
||
|
||
if (code == PLUS && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE (op0) != VOIDmode)
|
||
return plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (op1));
|
||
else if (code == MINUS && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE (op0) != VOIDmode)
|
||
return plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1));
|
||
else
|
||
return gen_rtx (code, mode, op0, op1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Like simplify_binary_operation except used for relational operators.
|
||
MODE is the mode of the operands, not that of the result. If MODE
|
||
is VOIDmode, both operands must also be VOIDmode and we compare the
|
||
operands in "infinite precision".
|
||
|
||
If no simplification is possible, this function returns zero. Otherwise,
|
||
it returns either const_true_rtx or const0_rtx. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
simplify_relational_operation (code, mode, op0, op1)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
{
|
||
int equal, op0lt, op0ltu, op1lt, op1ltu;
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
|
||
/* If op0 is a compare, extract the comparison arguments from it. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == COMPARE && op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
op1 = XEXP (op0, 1), op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* We can't simplify MODE_CC values since we don't know what the
|
||
actual comparison is. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_CC
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
|| op0 == cc0_rtx
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* For integer comparisons of A and B maybe we can simplify A - B and can
|
||
then simplify a comparison of that with zero. If A and B are both either
|
||
a register or a CONST_INT, this can't help; testing for these cases will
|
||
prevent infinite recursion here and speed things up.
|
||
|
||
If CODE is an unsigned comparison, we can only do this if A - B is a
|
||
constant integer, and then we have to compare that integer with zero as a
|
||
signed comparison. Note that this will give the incorrect result from
|
||
comparisons that overflow. Since these are undefined, this is probably
|
||
OK. If it causes a problem, we can check for A or B being an address
|
||
(fp + const or SYMBOL_REF) and only do it in that case. */
|
||
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) && op1 != const0_rtx
|
||
&& ! ((GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op1) == REG || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT))
|
||
&& 0 != (tem = simplify_binary_operation (MINUS, mode, op0, op1))
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (tem) == CONST_INT
|
||
|| (code != GTU && code != GEU &&
|
||
code != LTU && code != LEU)))
|
||
return simplify_relational_operation (signed_condition (code),
|
||
mode, tem, const0_rtx);
|
||
|
||
/* For non-IEEE floating-point, if the two operands are equal, we know the
|
||
result. */
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1)
|
||
&& (TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT != IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
|| ! FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)) || flag_fast_math))
|
||
equal = 1, op0lt = 0, op0ltu = 0, op1lt = 0, op1ltu = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If the operands are floating-point constants, see if we can fold
|
||
the result. */
|
||
#if ! defined (REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE) || defined (REAL_ARITHMETIC)
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d0, d1;
|
||
jmp_buf handler;
|
||
|
||
if (setjmp (handler))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
set_float_handler (handler);
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d0, op0);
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d1, op1);
|
||
equal = REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d0, d1);
|
||
op0lt = op0ltu = REAL_VALUES_LESS (d0, d1);
|
||
op1lt = op1ltu = REAL_VALUES_LESS (d1, d0);
|
||
set_float_handler (NULL_PTR);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* not REAL_IS_NOT_DOUBLE, or REAL_ARITHMETIC */
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, see if the operands are both integers. */
|
||
else if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT || mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT))
|
||
{
|
||
int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT l0s, h0s, l1s, h1s;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l0u, h0u, l1u, h1u;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the two words comprising each integer constant. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
||
{
|
||
l0u = l0s = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op0);
|
||
h0u = h0s = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
l0u = l0s = INTVAL (op0);
|
||
h0u = 0, h0s = l0s < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
||
{
|
||
l1u = l1s = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op1);
|
||
h1u = h1s = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op1);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
l1u = l1s = INTVAL (op1);
|
||
h1u = 0, h1s = l1s < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If WIDTH is nonzero and smaller than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT,
|
||
we have to sign or zero-extend the values. */
|
||
if (width != 0 && width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
h0u = h1u = 0, h0s = l0s < 0 ? -1 : 0, h1s = l1s < 0 ? -1 : 0;
|
||
|
||
if (width != 0 && width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
l0u &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
l1u &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
if (l0s & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1)))
|
||
l0s |= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width);
|
||
|
||
if (l1s & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1)))
|
||
l1s |= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
equal = (h0u == h1u && l0u == l1u);
|
||
op0lt = (h0s < h1s || (h0s == h1s && l0s < l1s));
|
||
op1lt = (h1s < h0s || (h1s == h0s && l1s < l0s));
|
||
op0ltu = (h0u < h1u || (h0u == h1u && l0u < l1u));
|
||
op1ltu = (h1u < h0u || (h1u == h0u && l1u < l0u));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, there are some code-specific tests we can make. */
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case EQ:
|
||
/* References to the frame plus a constant or labels cannot
|
||
be zero, but a SYMBOL_REF can due to #pragma weak. */
|
||
if (((NONZERO_BASE_PLUS_P (op0) && op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (op0) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
#if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
/* On some machines, the ap reg can be 0 sometimes. */
|
||
&& op0 != arg_pointer_rtx
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NE:
|
||
if (((NONZERO_BASE_PLUS_P (op0) && op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (op0) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
#if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& op0 != arg_pointer_rtx
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
return const_true_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case GEU:
|
||
/* Unsigned values are never negative. */
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return const_true_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LTU:
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LEU:
|
||
/* Unsigned values are never greater than the largest
|
||
unsigned value. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op1) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode)
|
||
&& INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
return const_true_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case GTU:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op1) == GET_MODE_MASK (mode)
|
||
&& INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we reach here, EQUAL, OP0LT, OP0LTU, OP1LT, and OP1LTU are set
|
||
as appropriate. */
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case EQ:
|
||
return equal ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case NE:
|
||
return ! equal ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case LT:
|
||
return op0lt ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case GT:
|
||
return op1lt ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case LTU:
|
||
return op0ltu ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case GTU:
|
||
return op1ltu ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case LE:
|
||
return equal || op0lt ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case GE:
|
||
return equal || op1lt ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case LEU:
|
||
return equal || op0ltu ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
case GEU:
|
||
return equal || op1ltu ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Simplify CODE, an operation with result mode MODE and three operands,
|
||
OP0, OP1, and OP2. OP0_MODE was the mode of OP0 before it became
|
||
a constant. Return 0 if no simplifications is possible. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
simplify_ternary_operation (code, mode, op0_mode, op0, op1, op2)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode, op0_mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1, op2;
|
||
{
|
||
int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* VOIDmode means "infinite" precision. */
|
||
if (width == 0)
|
||
width = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case SIGN_EXTRACT:
|
||
case ZERO_EXTRACT:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op1) + INTVAL (op2) <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op0_mode)
|
||
&& width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Extracting a bit-field from a constant */
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (op0);
|
||
|
||
#if BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
val >>= (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op0_mode) - INTVAL (op2) - INTVAL (op1));
|
||
#else
|
||
val >>= INTVAL (op2);
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT != INTVAL (op1))
|
||
{
|
||
/* First zero-extend. */
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (op1)) - 1;
|
||
/* If desired, propagate sign bit. */
|
||
if (code == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
||
&& (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (INTVAL (op1) - 1))))
|
||
val |= ~ (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (op1)) - 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the bits that don't belong in our mode,
|
||
unless they and our sign bit are all one.
|
||
So we get either a reasonable negative value or a reasonable
|
||
unsigned value for this mode. */
|
||
if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& ((val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1)))
|
||
!= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << (width - 1))))
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
|
||
return GEN_INT (val);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IF_THEN_ELSE:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return op0 != const0_rtx ? op1 : op2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a nontrivial arithmetic operation on an argument
|
||
for which a constant value can be determined, return
|
||
the result of operating on that value, as a constant.
|
||
Otherwise, return X, possibly with one or more operands
|
||
modified by recursive calls to this function.
|
||
|
||
If X is a register whose contents are known, we do NOT
|
||
return those contents here. equiv_constant is called to
|
||
perform that task.
|
||
|
||
INSN is the insn that we may be modifying. If it is 0, make a copy
|
||
of X before modifying it. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
fold_rtx (x, insn)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
{
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
register enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
register char *fmt;
|
||
register int i;
|
||
rtx new = 0;
|
||
int copied = 0;
|
||
int must_swap = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Folded equivalents of first two operands of X. */
|
||
rtx folded_arg0;
|
||
rtx folded_arg1;
|
||
|
||
/* Constant equivalents of first three operands of X;
|
||
0 when no such equivalent is known. */
|
||
rtx const_arg0;
|
||
rtx const_arg1;
|
||
rtx const_arg2;
|
||
|
||
/* The mode of the first operand of X. We need this for sign and zero
|
||
extends. */
|
||
enum machine_mode mode_arg0;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
mode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case REG:
|
||
/* No use simplifying an EXPR_LIST
|
||
since they are used only for lists of args
|
||
in a function call's REG_EQUAL note. */
|
||
case EXPR_LIST:
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
return prev_insn_cc0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
case PC:
|
||
/* If the next insn is a CODE_LABEL followed by a jump table,
|
||
PC's value is a LABEL_REF pointing to that label. That
|
||
lets us fold switch statements on the Vax. */
|
||
if (insn && GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx next = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
|
||
|
||
if (next && GET_CODE (next) == CODE_LABEL
|
||
&& NEXT_INSN (next) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (next)) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (next))) == ADDR_VEC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (next))) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC))
|
||
return gen_rtx (LABEL_REF, Pmode, next);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SUBREG:
|
||
/* See if we previously assigned a constant value to this SUBREG. */
|
||
if ((new = lookup_as_function (x, CONST_INT)) != 0
|
||
|| (new = lookup_as_function (x, CONST_DOUBLE)) != 0)
|
||
return new;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a paradoxical SUBREG, we have no idea what value the
|
||
extra bits would have. However, if the operand is equivalent
|
||
to a SUBREG whose operand is the same as our mode, and all the
|
||
modes are within a word, we can just use the inner operand
|
||
because these SUBREGs just say how to treat the register.
|
||
|
||
Similarly if we find an integer constant. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x));
|
||
struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& (elt = lookup (SUBREG_REG (x), HASH (SUBREG_REG (x), imode),
|
||
imode)) != 0)
|
||
for (elt = elt->first_same_value;
|
||
elt; elt = elt->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (elt->exp)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (elt->exp) == VOIDmode)
|
||
return elt->exp;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (elt->exp) == SUBREG
|
||
&& GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (elt->exp)) == mode
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (elt->exp, elt->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
return copy_rtx (SUBREG_REG (elt->exp));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Fold SUBREG_REG. If it changed, see if we can simplify the SUBREG.
|
||
We might be able to if the SUBREG is extracting a single word in an
|
||
integral mode or extracting the low part. */
|
||
|
||
folded_arg0 = fold_rtx (SUBREG_REG (x), insn);
|
||
const_arg0 = equiv_constant (folded_arg0);
|
||
if (const_arg0)
|
||
folded_arg0 = const_arg0;
|
||
|
||
if (folded_arg0 != SUBREG_REG (x))
|
||
{
|
||
new = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == UNITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) != VOIDmode)
|
||
new = operand_subword (folded_arg0, SUBREG_WORD (x), 0,
|
||
GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)));
|
||
if (new == 0 && subreg_lowpart_p (x))
|
||
new = gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode, folded_arg0);
|
||
if (new)
|
||
return new;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a narrowing SUBREG and our operand is a REG, see if
|
||
we can find an equivalence for REG that is an arithmetic operation
|
||
in a wider mode where both operands are paradoxical SUBREGs
|
||
from objects of our result mode. In that case, we couldn't report
|
||
an equivalent value for that operation, since we don't know what the
|
||
extra bits will be. But we can find an equivalence for this SUBREG
|
||
by folding that operation is the narrow mode. This allows us to
|
||
fold arithmetic in narrow modes when the machine only supports
|
||
word-sized arithmetic.
|
||
|
||
Also look for a case where we have a SUBREG whose operand is the
|
||
same as our result. If both modes are smaller than a word, we
|
||
are simply interpreting a register in different modes and we
|
||
can use the inner value. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == REG
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (folded_arg0))
|
||
&& subreg_lowpart_p (x))
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
/* We can use HASH here since we know that canon_hash won't be
|
||
called. */
|
||
elt = lookup (folded_arg0,
|
||
HASH (folded_arg0, GET_MODE (folded_arg0)),
|
||
GET_MODE (folded_arg0));
|
||
|
||
if (elt)
|
||
elt = elt->first_same_value;
|
||
|
||
for (; elt; elt = elt->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code eltcode = GET_CODE (elt->exp);
|
||
|
||
/* Just check for unary and binary operations. */
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (elt->exp)) == '1'
|
||
&& GET_CODE (elt->exp) != SIGN_EXTEND
|
||
&& GET_CODE (elt->exp) != ZERO_EXTEND
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (elt->exp, 0)) == SUBREG
|
||
&& GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (elt->exp, 0))) == mode)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx op0 = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (elt->exp, 0));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) != REG && ! CONSTANT_P (op0))
|
||
op0 = fold_rtx (op0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
op0 = equiv_constant (op0);
|
||
if (op0)
|
||
new = simplify_unary_operation (GET_CODE (elt->exp), mode,
|
||
op0, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (elt->exp)) == '2'
|
||
|| GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (elt->exp)) == 'c')
|
||
&& eltcode != DIV && eltcode != MOD
|
||
&& eltcode != UDIV && eltcode != UMOD
|
||
&& eltcode != ASHIFTRT && eltcode != LSHIFTRT
|
||
&& eltcode != ROTATE && eltcode != ROTATERT
|
||
&& ((GET_CODE (XEXP (elt->exp, 0)) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (elt->exp, 0)))
|
||
== mode))
|
||
|| CONSTANT_P (XEXP (elt->exp, 0)))
|
||
&& ((GET_CODE (XEXP (elt->exp, 1)) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (elt->exp, 1)))
|
||
== mode))
|
||
|| CONSTANT_P (XEXP (elt->exp, 1))))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx op0 = gen_lowpart_common (mode, XEXP (elt->exp, 0));
|
||
rtx op1 = gen_lowpart_common (mode, XEXP (elt->exp, 1));
|
||
|
||
if (op0 && GET_CODE (op0) != REG && ! CONSTANT_P (op0))
|
||
op0 = fold_rtx (op0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
if (op0)
|
||
op0 = equiv_constant (op0);
|
||
|
||
if (op1 && GET_CODE (op1) != REG && ! CONSTANT_P (op1))
|
||
op1 = fold_rtx (op1, NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
if (op1)
|
||
op1 = equiv_constant (op1);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are looking for the low SImode part of
|
||
(ashift:DI c (const_int 32)), it doesn't work
|
||
to compute that in SImode, because a 32-bit shift
|
||
in SImode is unpredictable. We know the value is 0. */
|
||
if (op0 && op1
|
||
&& GET_CODE (elt->exp) == ASHIFT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (op1) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
if (INTVAL (op1) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (elt->exp)))
|
||
|
||
/* If the count fits in the inner mode's width,
|
||
but exceeds the outer mode's width,
|
||
the value will get truncated to 0
|
||
by the subreg. */
|
||
new = const0_rtx;
|
||
else
|
||
/* If the count exceeds even the inner mode's width,
|
||
don't fold this expression. */
|
||
new = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (op0 && op1)
|
||
new = simplify_binary_operation (GET_CODE (elt->exp), mode,
|
||
op0, op1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (elt->exp) == SUBREG
|
||
&& GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (elt->exp)) == mode
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (folded_arg0))
|
||
<= UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
&& exp_equiv_p (elt->exp, elt->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
new = copy_rtx (SUBREG_REG (elt->exp));
|
||
|
||
if (new)
|
||
return new;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
case NOT:
|
||
case NEG:
|
||
/* If we have (NOT Y), see if Y is known to be (NOT Z).
|
||
If so, (NOT Y) simplifies to Z. Similarly for NEG. */
|
||
new = lookup_as_function (XEXP (x, 0), code);
|
||
if (new)
|
||
return fold_rtx (copy_rtx (XEXP (new, 0)), insn);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
/* If we are not actually processing an insn, don't try to find the
|
||
best address. Not only don't we care, but we could modify the
|
||
MEM in an invalid way since we have no insn to validate against. */
|
||
if (insn != 0)
|
||
find_best_addr (insn, &XEXP (x, 0));
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
/* Even if we don't fold in the insn itself,
|
||
we can safely do so here, in hopes of getting a constant. */
|
||
rtx addr = fold_rtx (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
rtx base = 0;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (addr))
|
||
&& GET_MODE (addr) == qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (addr)]]
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (addr)]] != 0)
|
||
addr = qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (addr)]];
|
||
|
||
/* If address is constant, split it into a base and integer offset. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (addr) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
base = addr;
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == PLUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
base = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0);
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1));
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == LO_SUM
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
||
base = XEXP (addr, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a constant pool reference, we can fold it into its
|
||
constant to allow better value tracking. */
|
||
if (base && GET_CODE (base) == SYMBOL_REF
|
||
&& CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (base))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx constant = get_pool_constant (base);
|
||
enum machine_mode const_mode = get_pool_mode (base);
|
||
rtx new;
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (constant) && GET_CODE (constant) != CONST_INT)
|
||
constant_pool_entries_cost = COST (constant);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are loading the full constant, we have an equivalence. */
|
||
if (offset == 0 && mode == const_mode)
|
||
return constant;
|
||
|
||
/* If this actually isn't a constant (wierd!), we can't do
|
||
anything. Otherwise, handle the two most common cases:
|
||
extracting a word from a multi-word constant, and extracting
|
||
the low-order bits. Other cases don't seem common enough to
|
||
worry about. */
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (constant))
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == UNITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& offset % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0
|
||
&& (new = operand_subword (constant,
|
||
offset / UNITS_PER_WORD,
|
||
0, const_mode)) != 0)
|
||
return new;
|
||
|
||
if (((BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
&& offset == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (constant)) - 1)
|
||
|| (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && offset == 0))
|
||
&& (new = gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode, constant)) != 0)
|
||
return new;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a reference to a label at a known position in a jump
|
||
table, we also know its value. */
|
||
if (base && GET_CODE (base) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx label = XEXP (base, 0);
|
||
rtx table_insn = NEXT_INSN (label);
|
||
|
||
if (table_insn && GET_CODE (table_insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (table_insn)) == ADDR_VEC)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx table = PATTERN (table_insn);
|
||
|
||
if (offset >= 0
|
||
&& (offset / GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (table))
|
||
< XVECLEN (table, 0)))
|
||
return XVECEXP (table, 0,
|
||
offset / GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (table)));
|
||
}
|
||
if (table_insn && GET_CODE (table_insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (table_insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx table = PATTERN (table_insn);
|
||
|
||
if (offset >= 0
|
||
&& (offset / GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (table))
|
||
< XVECLEN (table, 1)))
|
||
{
|
||
offset /= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (table));
|
||
new = gen_rtx (MINUS, Pmode, XVECEXP (table, 1, offset),
|
||
XEXP (table, 0));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE (table) != Pmode)
|
||
new = gen_rtx (TRUNCATE, GET_MODE (table), new);
|
||
|
||
/* Indicate this is a constant. This isn't a
|
||
valid form of CONST, but it will only be used
|
||
to fold the next insns and then discarded, so
|
||
it should be safe. */
|
||
return gen_rtx (CONST, GET_MODE (new), new);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
const_arg0 = 0;
|
||
const_arg1 = 0;
|
||
const_arg2 = 0;
|
||
mode_arg0 = VOIDmode;
|
||
|
||
/* Try folding our operands.
|
||
Then see which ones have constant values known. */
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
{
|
||
rtx arg = XEXP (x, i);
|
||
rtx folded_arg = arg, const_arg = 0;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode_arg = GET_MODE (arg);
|
||
rtx cheap_arg, expensive_arg;
|
||
rtx replacements[2];
|
||
int j;
|
||
|
||
/* Most arguments are cheap, so handle them specially. */
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (arg))
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
/* This is the same as calling equiv_constant; it is duplicated
|
||
here for speed. */
|
||
if (REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (arg))
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (arg)]] != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (arg)]]) != REG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (arg)]]) != PLUS)
|
||
const_arg
|
||
= gen_lowpart_if_possible (GET_MODE (arg),
|
||
qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (arg)]]);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
const_arg = arg;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
folded_arg = prev_insn_cc0;
|
||
mode_arg = prev_insn_cc0_mode;
|
||
const_arg = equiv_constant (folded_arg);
|
||
break;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
folded_arg = fold_rtx (arg, insn);
|
||
const_arg = equiv_constant (folded_arg);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For the first three operands, see if the operand
|
||
is constant or equivalent to a constant. */
|
||
switch (i)
|
||
{
|
||
case 0:
|
||
folded_arg0 = folded_arg;
|
||
const_arg0 = const_arg;
|
||
mode_arg0 = mode_arg;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 1:
|
||
folded_arg1 = folded_arg;
|
||
const_arg1 = const_arg;
|
||
break;
|
||
case 2:
|
||
const_arg2 = const_arg;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pick the least expensive of the folded argument and an
|
||
equivalent constant argument. */
|
||
if (const_arg == 0 || const_arg == folded_arg
|
||
|| COST (const_arg) > COST (folded_arg))
|
||
cheap_arg = folded_arg, expensive_arg = const_arg;
|
||
else
|
||
cheap_arg = const_arg, expensive_arg = folded_arg;
|
||
|
||
/* Try to replace the operand with the cheapest of the two
|
||
possibilities. If it doesn't work and this is either of the first
|
||
two operands of a commutative operation, try swapping them.
|
||
If THAT fails, try the more expensive, provided it is cheaper
|
||
than what is already there. */
|
||
|
||
if (cheap_arg == XEXP (x, i))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (insn == 0 && ! copied)
|
||
{
|
||
x = copy_rtx (x);
|
||
copied = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
replacements[0] = cheap_arg, replacements[1] = expensive_arg;
|
||
for (j = 0;
|
||
j < 2 && replacements[j]
|
||
&& COST (replacements[j]) < COST (XEXP (x, i));
|
||
j++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, i), replacements[j], 0))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (code == NE || code == EQ || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'c')
|
||
{
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, i), XEXP (x, 1 - i), 1);
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, 1 - i), replacements[j], 1);
|
||
|
||
if (apply_change_group ())
|
||
{
|
||
/* Swap them back to be invalid so that this loop can
|
||
continue and flag them to be swapped back later. */
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
|
||
tem = XEXP (x, 0); XEXP (x, 0) = XEXP (x, 1);
|
||
XEXP (x, 1) = tem;
|
||
must_swap = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
/* Don't try to fold inside of a vector of expressions.
|
||
Doing nothing is harmless. */
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
/* If a commutative operation, place a constant integer as the second
|
||
operand unless the first operand is also a constant integer. Otherwise,
|
||
place any constant second unless the first operand is also a constant. */
|
||
|
||
if (code == EQ || code == NE || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'c')
|
||
{
|
||
if (must_swap || (const_arg0
|
||
&& (const_arg1 == 0
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (const_arg0) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (const_arg1) != CONST_INT))))
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx tem = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (insn == 0 && ! copied)
|
||
{
|
||
x = copy_rtx (x);
|
||
copied = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1), 1);
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (x, 1), tem, 1);
|
||
if (apply_change_group ())
|
||
{
|
||
tem = const_arg0, const_arg0 = const_arg1, const_arg1 = tem;
|
||
tem = folded_arg0, folded_arg0 = folded_arg1, folded_arg1 = tem;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If X is an arithmetic operation, see if we can simplify it. */
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_RTX_CLASS (code))
|
||
{
|
||
case '1':
|
||
{
|
||
int is_const = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We can't simplify extension ops unless we know the
|
||
original mode. */
|
||
if ((code == ZERO_EXTEND || code == SIGN_EXTEND)
|
||
&& mode_arg0 == VOIDmode)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* If we had a CONST, strip it off and put it back later if we
|
||
fold. */
|
||
if (const_arg0 != 0 && GET_CODE (const_arg0) == CONST)
|
||
is_const = 1, const_arg0 = XEXP (const_arg0, 0);
|
||
|
||
new = simplify_unary_operation (code, mode,
|
||
const_arg0 ? const_arg0 : folded_arg0,
|
||
mode_arg0);
|
||
if (new != 0 && is_const)
|
||
new = gen_rtx (CONST, mode, new);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case '<':
|
||
/* See what items are actually being compared and set FOLDED_ARG[01]
|
||
to those values and CODE to the actual comparison code. If any are
|
||
constant, set CONST_ARG0 and CONST_ARG1 appropriately. We needn't
|
||
do anything if both operands are already known to be constant. */
|
||
|
||
if (const_arg0 == 0 || const_arg1 == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *p0, *p1;
|
||
rtx true = const_true_rtx, false = const0_rtx;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode_arg1;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
true = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE,
|
||
mode);
|
||
false = CONST0_RTX (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
code = find_comparison_args (code, &folded_arg0, &folded_arg1,
|
||
&mode_arg0, &mode_arg1);
|
||
const_arg0 = equiv_constant (folded_arg0);
|
||
const_arg1 = equiv_constant (folded_arg1);
|
||
|
||
/* If the mode is VOIDmode or a MODE_CC mode, we don't know
|
||
what kinds of things are being compared, so we can't do
|
||
anything with this comparison. */
|
||
|
||
if (mode_arg0 == VOIDmode || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode_arg0) == MODE_CC)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* If we do not now have two constants being compared, see if we
|
||
can nevertheless deduce some things about the comparison. */
|
||
if (const_arg0 == 0 || const_arg1 == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Is FOLDED_ARG0 frame-pointer plus a constant? Or non-explicit
|
||
constant? These aren't zero, but we don't know their sign. */
|
||
if (const_arg1 == const0_rtx
|
||
&& (NONZERO_BASE_PLUS_P (folded_arg0)
|
||
#if 0 /* Sad to say, on sysvr4, #pragma weak can make a symbol address
|
||
come out as 0. */
|
||
|| GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == SYMBOL_REF
|
||
#endif
|
||
|| GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == LABEL_REF
|
||
|| GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == CONST))
|
||
{
|
||
if (code == EQ)
|
||
return false;
|
||
else if (code == NE)
|
||
return true;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* See if the two operands are the same. We don't do this
|
||
for IEEE floating-point since we can't assume x == x
|
||
since x might be a NaN. */
|
||
|
||
if ((TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT != IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
||
|| ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode_arg0) || flag_fast_math)
|
||
&& (folded_arg0 == folded_arg1
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == REG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (folded_arg1) == REG
|
||
&& (reg_qty[REGNO (folded_arg0)]
|
||
== reg_qty[REGNO (folded_arg1)]))
|
||
|| ((p0 = lookup (folded_arg0,
|
||
(safe_hash (folded_arg0, mode_arg0)
|
||
% NBUCKETS), mode_arg0))
|
||
&& (p1 = lookup (folded_arg1,
|
||
(safe_hash (folded_arg1, mode_arg0)
|
||
% NBUCKETS), mode_arg0))
|
||
&& p0->first_same_value == p1->first_same_value)))
|
||
return ((code == EQ || code == LE || code == GE
|
||
|| code == LEU || code == GEU)
|
||
? true : false);
|
||
|
||
/* If FOLDED_ARG0 is a register, see if the comparison we are
|
||
doing now is either the same as we did before or the reverse
|
||
(we only check the reverse if not floating-point). */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
int qty = reg_qty[REGNO (folded_arg0)];
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (folded_arg0))
|
||
&& (comparison_dominates_p (qty_comparison_code[qty], code)
|
||
|| (comparison_dominates_p (qty_comparison_code[qty],
|
||
reverse_condition (code))
|
||
&& ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode_arg0)))
|
||
&& (rtx_equal_p (qty_comparison_const[qty], folded_arg1)
|
||
|| (const_arg1
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (qty_comparison_const[qty],
|
||
const_arg1))
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (folded_arg1) == REG
|
||
&& (reg_qty[REGNO (folded_arg1)]
|
||
== qty_comparison_qty[qty]))))
|
||
return (comparison_dominates_p (qty_comparison_code[qty],
|
||
code)
|
||
? true : false);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we are comparing against zero, see if the first operand is
|
||
equivalent to an IOR with a constant. If so, we may be able to
|
||
determine the result of this comparison. */
|
||
|
||
if (const_arg1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx y = lookup_as_function (folded_arg0, IOR);
|
||
rtx inner_const;
|
||
|
||
if (y != 0
|
||
&& (inner_const = equiv_constant (XEXP (y, 1))) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (inner_const) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (inner_const) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
int sign_bitnum = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode_arg0) - 1;
|
||
int has_sign = (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= sign_bitnum
|
||
&& (INTVAL (inner_const)
|
||
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << sign_bitnum)));
|
||
rtx true = const_true_rtx, false = const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
true = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE,
|
||
mode);
|
||
false = CONST0_RTX (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case EQ:
|
||
return false;
|
||
case NE:
|
||
return true;
|
||
case LT: case LE:
|
||
if (has_sign)
|
||
return true;
|
||
break;
|
||
case GT: case GE:
|
||
if (has_sign)
|
||
return false;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
new = simplify_relational_operation (code, mode_arg0,
|
||
const_arg0 ? const_arg0 : folded_arg0,
|
||
const_arg1 ? const_arg1 : folded_arg1);
|
||
#ifdef FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
||
if (new != 0 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
new = ((new == const0_rtx) ? CONST0_RTX (mode)
|
||
: CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE, mode));
|
||
#endif
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case '2':
|
||
case 'c':
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
/* If the second operand is a LABEL_REF, see if the first is a MINUS
|
||
with that LABEL_REF as its second operand. If so, the result is
|
||
the first operand of that MINUS. This handles switches with an
|
||
ADDR_DIFF_VEC table. */
|
||
if (const_arg1 && GET_CODE (const_arg1) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx y
|
||
= GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == MINUS ? folded_arg0
|
||
: lookup_as_function (folded_arg0, MINUS);
|
||
|
||
if (y != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& XEXP (XEXP (y, 1), 0) == XEXP (const_arg1, 0))
|
||
return XEXP (y, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Now try for a CONST of a MINUS like the above. */
|
||
if ((y = (GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == CONST ? folded_arg0
|
||
: lookup_as_function (folded_arg0, CONST))) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == MINUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (y, 0), 1)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (y, 0),1), 0) == XEXP (const_arg1, 0))
|
||
return XEXP (XEXP (y, 0), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Likewise if the operands are in the other order. */
|
||
if (const_arg0 && GET_CODE (const_arg0) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx y
|
||
= GET_CODE (folded_arg1) == MINUS ? folded_arg1
|
||
: lookup_as_function (folded_arg1, MINUS);
|
||
|
||
if (y != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& XEXP (XEXP (y, 1), 0) == XEXP (const_arg0, 0))
|
||
return XEXP (y, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Now try for a CONST of a MINUS like the above. */
|
||
if ((y = (GET_CODE (folded_arg1) == CONST ? folded_arg1
|
||
: lookup_as_function (folded_arg1, CONST))) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == MINUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (y, 0), 1)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (y, 0),1), 0) == XEXP (const_arg0, 0))
|
||
return XEXP (XEXP (y, 0), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If second operand is a register equivalent to a negative
|
||
CONST_INT, see if we can find a register equivalent to the
|
||
positive constant. Make a MINUS if so. Don't do this for
|
||
a negative constant since we might then alternate between
|
||
chosing positive and negative constants. Having the positive
|
||
constant previously-used is the more common case. */
|
||
if (const_arg1 && GET_CODE (const_arg1) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (const_arg1) < 0 && GET_CODE (folded_arg1) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new_const = GEN_INT (- INTVAL (const_arg1));
|
||
struct table_elt *p
|
||
= lookup (new_const, safe_hash (new_const, mode) % NBUCKETS,
|
||
mode);
|
||
|
||
if (p)
|
||
for (p = p->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == REG)
|
||
return cse_gen_binary (MINUS, mode, folded_arg0,
|
||
canon_reg (p->exp, NULL_RTX));
|
||
}
|
||
goto from_plus;
|
||
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
/* If we have (MINUS Y C), see if Y is known to be (PLUS Z C2).
|
||
If so, produce (PLUS Z C2-C). */
|
||
if (const_arg1 != 0 && GET_CODE (const_arg1) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx y = lookup_as_function (XEXP (x, 0), PLUS);
|
||
if (y && GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return fold_rtx (plus_constant (copy_rtx (y),
|
||
-INTVAL (const_arg1)),
|
||
NULL_RTX);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
from_plus:
|
||
case SMIN: case SMAX: case UMIN: case UMAX:
|
||
case IOR: case AND: case XOR:
|
||
case MULT: case DIV: case UDIV:
|
||
case ASHIFT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFTRT:
|
||
/* If we have (<op> <reg> <const_int>) for an associative OP and REG
|
||
is known to be of similar form, we may be able to replace the
|
||
operation with a combined operation. This may eliminate the
|
||
intermediate operation if every use is simplified in this way.
|
||
Note that the similar optimization done by combine.c only works
|
||
if the intermediate operation's result has only one reference. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (folded_arg0) == REG
|
||
&& const_arg1 && GET_CODE (const_arg1) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
int is_shift
|
||
= (code == ASHIFT || code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT);
|
||
rtx y = lookup_as_function (folded_arg0, code);
|
||
rtx inner_const;
|
||
enum rtx_code associate_code;
|
||
rtx new_const;
|
||
|
||
if (y == 0
|
||
|| 0 == (inner_const
|
||
= equiv_constant (fold_rtx (XEXP (y, 1), 0)))
|
||
|| GET_CODE (inner_const) != CONST_INT
|
||
/* If we have compiled a statement like
|
||
"if (x == (x & mask1))", and now are looking at
|
||
"x & mask2", we will have a case where the first operand
|
||
of Y is the same as our first operand. Unless we detect
|
||
this case, an infinite loop will result. */
|
||
|| XEXP (y, 0) == folded_arg0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't associate these operations if they are a PLUS with the
|
||
same constant and it is a power of two. These might be doable
|
||
with a pre- or post-increment. Similarly for two subtracts of
|
||
identical powers of two with post decrement. */
|
||
|
||
if (code == PLUS && INTVAL (const_arg1) == INTVAL (inner_const)
|
||
&& (0
|
||
#if defined(HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT) || defined(HAVE_POST_INCREMENT)
|
||
|| exact_log2 (INTVAL (const_arg1)) >= 0
|
||
#endif
|
||
#if defined(HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT) || defined(HAVE_POST_DECREMENT)
|
||
|| exact_log2 (- INTVAL (const_arg1)) >= 0
|
||
#endif
|
||
))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the code used to compose the constants. For example,
|
||
A/C1/C2 is A/(C1 * C2), so if CODE == DIV, we want MULT. */
|
||
|
||
associate_code
|
||
= (code == MULT || code == DIV || code == UDIV ? MULT
|
||
: is_shift || code == PLUS || code == MINUS ? PLUS : code);
|
||
|
||
new_const = simplify_binary_operation (associate_code, mode,
|
||
const_arg1, inner_const);
|
||
|
||
if (new_const == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* If we are associating shift operations, don't let this
|
||
produce a shift of the size of the object or larger.
|
||
This could occur when we follow a sign-extend by a right
|
||
shift on a machine that does a sign-extend as a pair
|
||
of shifts. */
|
||
|
||
if (is_shift && GET_CODE (new_const) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (new_const) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
/* As an exception, we can turn an ASHIFTRT of this
|
||
form into a shift of the number of bits - 1. */
|
||
if (code == ASHIFTRT)
|
||
new_const = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1);
|
||
else
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
y = copy_rtx (XEXP (y, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* If Y contains our first operand (the most common way this
|
||
can happen is if Y is a MEM), we would do into an infinite
|
||
loop if we tried to fold it. So don't in that case. */
|
||
|
||
if (! reg_mentioned_p (folded_arg0, y))
|
||
y = fold_rtx (y, insn);
|
||
|
||
return cse_gen_binary (code, mode, y, new_const);
|
||
}
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
new = simplify_binary_operation (code, mode,
|
||
const_arg0 ? const_arg0 : folded_arg0,
|
||
const_arg1 ? const_arg1 : folded_arg1);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 'o':
|
||
/* (lo_sum (high X) X) is simply X. */
|
||
if (code == LO_SUM && const_arg0 != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (const_arg0) == HIGH
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (XEXP (const_arg0, 0), const_arg1))
|
||
return const_arg1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case '3':
|
||
case 'b':
|
||
new = simplify_ternary_operation (code, mode, mode_arg0,
|
||
const_arg0 ? const_arg0 : folded_arg0,
|
||
const_arg1 ? const_arg1 : folded_arg1,
|
||
const_arg2 ? const_arg2 : XEXP (x, 2));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return new ? new : x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a constant value currently equivalent to X.
|
||
Return 0 if we don't know one. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
equiv_constant (x)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (x))
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]])
|
||
x = gen_lowpart_if_possible (GET_MODE (x), qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (x)]]);
|
||
|
||
if (x != 0 && CONSTANT_P (x))
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a MEM, try to fold it outside the context of any insn to see if
|
||
it might be equivalent to a constant. That handles the case where it
|
||
is a constant-pool reference. Then try to look it up in the hash table
|
||
in case it is something whose value we have seen before. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
x = fold_rtx (x, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (x))
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
elt = lookup (x, safe_hash (x, GET_MODE (x)) % NBUCKETS, GET_MODE (x));
|
||
if (elt == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
for (elt = elt->first_same_value; elt; elt = elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (elt->is_const && CONSTANT_P (elt->exp))
|
||
return elt->exp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Assuming that X is an rtx (e.g., MEM, REG or SUBREG) for a fixed-point
|
||
number, return an rtx (MEM, SUBREG, or CONST_INT) that refers to the
|
||
least-significant part of X.
|
||
MODE specifies how big a part of X to return.
|
||
|
||
If the requested operation cannot be done, 0 is returned.
|
||
|
||
This is similar to gen_lowpart in emit-rtl.c. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode, x)
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
register rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx result = gen_lowpart_common (mode, x);
|
||
|
||
if (result)
|
||
return result;
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is the only other case we handle. */
|
||
register int offset = 0;
|
||
rtx new;
|
||
|
||
#if WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
offset = (MAX (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)), UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
- MAX (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), UNITS_PER_WORD));
|
||
#endif
|
||
#if BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
/* Adjust the address so that the address-after-the-data
|
||
is unchanged. */
|
||
offset -= (MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
|
||
- MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
|
||
#endif
|
||
new = gen_rtx (MEM, mode, plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), offset));
|
||
if (! memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (new, 0)))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
MEM_VOLATILE_P (new) = MEM_VOLATILE_P (x);
|
||
RTX_UNCHANGING_P (new) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x);
|
||
MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (new) = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (x);
|
||
return new;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given INSN, a jump insn, TAKEN indicates if we are following the "taken"
|
||
branch. It will be zero if not.
|
||
|
||
In certain cases, this can cause us to add an equivalence. For example,
|
||
if we are following the taken case of
|
||
if (i == 2)
|
||
we can add the fact that `i' and '2' are now equivalent.
|
||
|
||
In any case, we can record that this comparison was passed. If the same
|
||
comparison is seen later, we will know its value. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
record_jump_equiv (insn, taken)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
int taken;
|
||
{
|
||
int cond_known_true;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode, mode0, mode1;
|
||
int reversed_nonequality = 0;
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
|
||
/* Ensure this is the right kind of insn. */
|
||
if (! condjump_p (insn) || simplejump_p (insn))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* See if this jump condition is known true or false. */
|
||
if (taken)
|
||
cond_known_true = (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 2) == pc_rtx);
|
||
else
|
||
cond_known_true = (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 1) == pc_rtx);
|
||
|
||
/* Get the type of comparison being done and the operands being compared.
|
||
If we had to reverse a non-equality condition, record that fact so we
|
||
know that it isn't valid for floating-point. */
|
||
code = GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 0));
|
||
op0 = fold_rtx (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 0), 0), insn);
|
||
op1 = fold_rtx (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 0), 1), insn);
|
||
|
||
code = find_comparison_args (code, &op0, &op1, &mode0, &mode1);
|
||
if (! cond_known_true)
|
||
{
|
||
reversed_nonequality = (code != EQ && code != NE);
|
||
code = reverse_condition (code);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The mode is the mode of the non-constant. */
|
||
mode = mode0;
|
||
if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
|
||
mode = mode1;
|
||
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, op0, op1, reversed_nonequality);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We know that comparison CODE applied to OP0 and OP1 in MODE is true.
|
||
REVERSED_NONEQUALITY is nonzero if CODE had to be swapped.
|
||
Make any useful entries we can with that information. Called from
|
||
above function and called recursively. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, op0, op1, reversed_nonequality)
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
int reversed_nonequality;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned op0_hash, op1_hash;
|
||
int op0_in_memory, op0_in_struct, op1_in_memory, op1_in_struct;
|
||
struct table_elt *op0_elt, *op1_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* If OP0 and OP1 are known equal, and either is a paradoxical SUBREG,
|
||
we know that they are also equal in the smaller mode (this is also
|
||
true for all smaller modes whether or not there is a SUBREG, but
|
||
is not worth testing for with no SUBREG. */
|
||
|
||
/* Note that GET_MODE (op0) may not equal MODE. */
|
||
if (code == EQ && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
|
||
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0));
|
||
rtx tem = gen_lowpart_if_possible (inner_mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, SUBREG_REG (op0),
|
||
tem ? tem : gen_rtx (SUBREG, inner_mode, op1, 0),
|
||
reversed_nonequality);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (code == EQ && GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op1))
|
||
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op1)))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op1));
|
||
rtx tem = gen_lowpart_if_possible (inner_mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, SUBREG_REG (op1),
|
||
tem ? tem : gen_rtx (SUBREG, inner_mode, op0, 0),
|
||
reversed_nonequality);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Similarly, if this is an NE comparison, and either is a SUBREG
|
||
making a smaller mode, we know the whole thing is also NE. */
|
||
|
||
/* Note that GET_MODE (op0) may not equal MODE;
|
||
if we test MODE instead, we can get an infinite recursion
|
||
alternating between two modes each wider than MODE. */
|
||
|
||
if (code == NE && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
|
||
&& subreg_lowpart_p (op0)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
|
||
< GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0));
|
||
rtx tem = gen_lowpart_if_possible (inner_mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, SUBREG_REG (op0),
|
||
tem ? tem : gen_rtx (SUBREG, inner_mode, op1, 0),
|
||
reversed_nonequality);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (code == NE && GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
|
||
&& subreg_lowpart_p (op1)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op1))
|
||
< GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op1)))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op1));
|
||
rtx tem = gen_lowpart_if_possible (inner_mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
record_jump_cond (code, mode, SUBREG_REG (op1),
|
||
tem ? tem : gen_rtx (SUBREG, inner_mode, op0, 0),
|
||
reversed_nonequality);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Hash both operands. */
|
||
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
op0_hash = HASH (op0, mode);
|
||
op0_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
op0_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
if (do_not_record)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
op1_hash = HASH (op1, mode);
|
||
op1_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
op1_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
if (do_not_record)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Look up both operands. */
|
||
op0_elt = lookup (op0, op0_hash, mode);
|
||
op1_elt = lookup (op1, op1_hash, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* If both operands are already equivalent or if they are not in the
|
||
table but are identical, do nothing. */
|
||
if ((op0_elt != 0 && op1_elt != 0
|
||
&& op0_elt->first_same_value == op1_elt->first_same_value)
|
||
|| op0 == op1 || rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If we aren't setting two things equal all we can do is save this
|
||
comparison. Similarly if this is floating-point. In the latter
|
||
case, OP1 might be zero and both -0.0 and 0.0 are equal to it.
|
||
If we record the equality, we might inadvertently delete code
|
||
whose intent was to change -0 to +0. */
|
||
|
||
if (code != EQ || FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we reversed a floating-point comparison, if OP0 is not a
|
||
register, or if OP1 is neither a register or constant, we can't
|
||
do anything. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) != REG)
|
||
op1 = equiv_constant (op1);
|
||
|
||
if ((reversed_nonequality && FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
|| GET_CODE (op0) != REG || op1 == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Put OP0 in the hash table if it isn't already. This gives it a
|
||
new quantity number. */
|
||
if (op0_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (insert_regs (op0, NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (op0);
|
||
op0_hash = HASH (op0, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* If OP0 is contained in OP1, this changes its hash code
|
||
as well. Faster to rehash than to check, except
|
||
for the simple case of a constant. */
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
|
||
op1_hash = HASH (op1,mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0_elt = insert (op0, NULL_PTR, op0_hash, mode);
|
||
op0_elt->in_memory = op0_in_memory;
|
||
op0_elt->in_struct = op0_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
qty_comparison_code[reg_qty[REGNO (op0)]] = code;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Look it up again--in case op0 and op1 are the same. */
|
||
op1_elt = lookup (op1, op1_hash, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* Put OP1 in the hash table so it gets a new quantity number. */
|
||
if (op1_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (insert_regs (op1, NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (op1);
|
||
op1_hash = HASH (op1, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op1_elt = insert (op1, NULL_PTR, op1_hash, mode);
|
||
op1_elt->in_memory = op1_in_memory;
|
||
op1_elt->in_struct = op1_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
qty_comparison_qty[reg_qty[REGNO (op0)]] = reg_qty[REGNO (op1)];
|
||
qty_comparison_const[reg_qty[REGNO (op0)]] = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
qty_comparison_qty[reg_qty[REGNO (op0)]] = -1;
|
||
qty_comparison_const[reg_qty[REGNO (op0)]] = op1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If either side is still missing an equivalence, make it now,
|
||
then merge the equivalences. */
|
||
|
||
if (op0_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (insert_regs (op0, NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (op0);
|
||
op0_hash = HASH (op0, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0_elt = insert (op0, NULL_PTR, op0_hash, mode);
|
||
op0_elt->in_memory = op0_in_memory;
|
||
op0_elt->in_struct = op0_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (op1_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (insert_regs (op1, NULL_PTR, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (op1);
|
||
op1_hash = HASH (op1, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op1_elt = insert (op1, NULL_PTR, op1_hash, mode);
|
||
op1_elt->in_memory = op1_in_memory;
|
||
op1_elt->in_struct = op1_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (op0_elt, op1_elt);
|
||
last_jump_equiv_class = op0_elt;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* CSE processing for one instruction.
|
||
First simplify sources and addresses of all assignments
|
||
in the instruction, using previously-computed equivalents values.
|
||
Then install the new sources and destinations in the table
|
||
of available values.
|
||
|
||
If IN_LIBCALL_BLOCK is nonzero, don't record any equivalence made in
|
||
the insn. */
|
||
|
||
/* Data on one SET contained in the instruction. */
|
||
|
||
struct set
|
||
{
|
||
/* The SET rtx itself. */
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
/* The SET_SRC of the rtx (the original value, if it is changing). */
|
||
rtx src;
|
||
/* The hash-table element for the SET_SRC of the SET. */
|
||
struct table_elt *src_elt;
|
||
/* Hash value for the SET_SRC. */
|
||
unsigned src_hash;
|
||
/* Hash value for the SET_DEST. */
|
||
unsigned dest_hash;
|
||
/* The SET_DEST, with SUBREG, etc., stripped. */
|
||
rtx inner_dest;
|
||
/* Place where the pointer to the INNER_DEST was found. */
|
||
rtx *inner_dest_loc;
|
||
/* Nonzero if the SET_SRC is in memory. */
|
||
char src_in_memory;
|
||
/* Nonzero if the SET_SRC is in a structure. */
|
||
char src_in_struct;
|
||
/* Nonzero if the SET_SRC contains something
|
||
whose value cannot be predicted and understood. */
|
||
char src_volatile;
|
||
/* Original machine mode, in case it becomes a CONST_INT. */
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
/* A constant equivalent for SET_SRC, if any. */
|
||
rtx src_const;
|
||
/* Hash value of constant equivalent for SET_SRC. */
|
||
unsigned src_const_hash;
|
||
/* Table entry for constant equivalent for SET_SRC, if any. */
|
||
struct table_elt *src_const_elt;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
cse_insn (insn, in_libcall_block)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
int in_libcall_block;
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx x = PATTERN (insn);
|
||
register int i;
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
register int n_sets = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Records what this insn does to set CC0. */
|
||
rtx this_insn_cc0 = 0;
|
||
enum machine_mode this_insn_cc0_mode;
|
||
struct write_data writes_memory;
|
||
static struct write_data init = {0, 0, 0, 0};
|
||
|
||
rtx src_eqv = 0;
|
||
struct table_elt *src_eqv_elt = 0;
|
||
int src_eqv_volatile;
|
||
int src_eqv_in_memory;
|
||
int src_eqv_in_struct;
|
||
unsigned src_eqv_hash;
|
||
|
||
struct set *sets;
|
||
|
||
this_insn = insn;
|
||
writes_memory = init;
|
||
|
||
/* Find all the SETs and CLOBBERs in this instruction.
|
||
Record all the SETs in the array `set' and count them.
|
||
Also determine whether there is a CLOBBER that invalidates
|
||
all memory references, or all references at varying addresses. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
||
{
|
||
for (tem = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (tem, 0)) == CLOBBER)
|
||
invalidate (SET_DEST (XEXP (tem, 0)), VOIDmode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
|
||
{
|
||
sets = (struct set *) alloca (sizeof (struct set));
|
||
sets[0].rtl = x;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore SETs that are unconditional jumps.
|
||
They never need cse processing, so this does not hurt.
|
||
The reason is not efficiency but rather
|
||
so that we can test at the end for instructions
|
||
that have been simplified to unconditional jumps
|
||
and not be misled by unchanged instructions
|
||
that were unconditional jumps to begin with. */
|
||
if (SET_DEST (x) == pc_rtx
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't count call-insns, (set (reg 0) (call ...)), as a set.
|
||
The hard function value register is used only once, to copy to
|
||
someplace else, so it isn't worth cse'ing (and on 80386 is unsafe)!
|
||
Ensure we invalidate the destination register. On the 80386 no
|
||
other code would invalidate it since it is a fixed_reg.
|
||
We need not check the return of apply_change_group; see canon_reg. */
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == CALL)
|
||
{
|
||
canon_reg (SET_SRC (x), insn);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
fold_rtx (SET_SRC (x), insn);
|
||
invalidate (SET_DEST (x), VOIDmode);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
n_sets = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
|
||
{
|
||
register int lim = XVECLEN (x, 0);
|
||
|
||
sets = (struct set *) alloca (lim * sizeof (struct set));
|
||
|
||
/* Find all regs explicitly clobbered in this insn,
|
||
and ensure they are not replaced with any other regs
|
||
elsewhere in this insn.
|
||
When a reg that is clobbered is also used for input,
|
||
we should presume that that is for a reason,
|
||
and we should not substitute some other register
|
||
which is not supposed to be clobbered.
|
||
Therefore, this loop cannot be merged into the one below
|
||
because a CALL may precede a CLOBBER and refer to the
|
||
value clobbered. We must not let a canonicalization do
|
||
anything in that case. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < lim; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx y = XVECEXP (x, 0, i);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (y) == CLOBBER)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx clobbered = XEXP (y, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (clobbered) == REG
|
||
|| GET_CODE (clobbered) == SUBREG)
|
||
invalidate (clobbered, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (clobbered) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (clobbered) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (clobbered, 0), GET_MODE (clobbered));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < lim; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx y = XVECEXP (x, 0, i);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (y) == SET)
|
||
{
|
||
/* As above, we ignore unconditional jumps and call-insns and
|
||
ignore the result of apply_change_group. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (y)) == CALL)
|
||
{
|
||
canon_reg (SET_SRC (y), insn);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
fold_rtx (SET_SRC (y), insn);
|
||
invalidate (SET_DEST (y), VOIDmode);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (SET_DEST (y) == pc_rtx
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (y)) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
sets[n_sets++].rtl = y;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (y) == CLOBBER)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we clobber memory, take note of that,
|
||
and canon the address.
|
||
This does nothing when a register is clobbered
|
||
because we have already invalidated the reg. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
canon_reg (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
note_mem_written (XEXP (y, 0), &writes_memory);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (y) == USE
|
||
&& ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (y, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
|
||
canon_reg (y, NULL_RTX);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (y) == CALL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The result of apply_change_group can be ignored; see
|
||
canon_reg. */
|
||
canon_reg (y, insn);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
fold_rtx (y, insn);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
canon_reg (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
note_mem_written (XEXP (x, 0), &writes_memory);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Canonicalize a USE of a pseudo register or memory location. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == USE
|
||
&& ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
|
||
canon_reg (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The result of apply_change_group can be ignored; see canon_reg. */
|
||
canon_reg (x, insn);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
fold_rtx (x, insn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store the equivalent value in SRC_EQV, if different, or if the DEST
|
||
is a STRICT_LOW_PART. The latter condition is necessary because SRC_EQV
|
||
is handled specially for this case, and if it isn't set, then there will
|
||
be no equivalence for the destinatation. */
|
||
if (n_sets == 1 && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0
|
||
&& (tem = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX)) != 0
|
||
&& (! rtx_equal_p (XEXP (tem, 0), SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl))
|
||
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl)) == STRICT_LOW_PART))
|
||
src_eqv = canon_reg (XEXP (tem, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
/* Canonicalize sources and addresses of destinations.
|
||
We do this in a separate pass to avoid problems when a MATCH_DUP is
|
||
present in the insn pattern. In that case, we want to ensure that
|
||
we don't break the duplicate nature of the pattern. So we will replace
|
||
both operands at the same time. Otherwise, we would fail to find an
|
||
equivalent substitution in the loop calling validate_change below.
|
||
|
||
We used to suppress canonicalization of DEST if it appears in SRC,
|
||
but we don't do this any more. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
rtx src = SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
rtx new = canon_reg (src, insn);
|
||
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (new) == REG && GET_CODE (src) == REG
|
||
&& ((REGNO (new) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
!= (REGNO (src) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
|
||
|| insn_n_dups[recog_memoized (insn)] > 0)
|
||
validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), new, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl) = new;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT || GET_CODE (dest) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
|
||
{
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (dest, 1),
|
||
canon_reg (XEXP (dest, 1), insn), 1);
|
||
validate_change (insn, &XEXP (dest, 2),
|
||
canon_reg (XEXP (dest, 2), insn), 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
while (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
|
||
dest = XEXP (dest, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
|
||
canon_reg (dest, insn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now that we have done all the replacements, we can apply the change
|
||
group and see if they all work. Note that this will cause some
|
||
canonicalizations that would have worked individually not to be applied
|
||
because some other canonicalization didn't work, but this should not
|
||
occur often.
|
||
|
||
The result of apply_change_group can be ignored; see canon_reg. */
|
||
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
|
||
/* Set sets[i].src_elt to the class each source belongs to.
|
||
Detect assignments from or to volatile things
|
||
and set set[i] to zero so they will be ignored
|
||
in the rest of this function.
|
||
|
||
Nothing in this loop changes the hash table or the register chains. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx src, dest;
|
||
register rtx src_folded;
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt = 0, *p;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
rtx src_eqv_here;
|
||
rtx src_const = 0;
|
||
rtx src_related = 0;
|
||
struct table_elt *src_const_elt = 0;
|
||
int src_cost = 10000, src_eqv_cost = 10000, src_folded_cost = 10000;
|
||
int src_related_cost = 10000, src_elt_cost = 10000;
|
||
/* Set non-zero if we need to call force_const_mem on with the
|
||
contents of src_folded before using it. */
|
||
int src_folded_force_flag = 0;
|
||
|
||
dest = SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
src = SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* If SRC is a constant that has no machine mode,
|
||
hash it with the destination's machine mode.
|
||
This way we can keep different modes separate. */
|
||
|
||
mode = GET_MODE (src) == VOIDmode ? GET_MODE (dest) : GET_MODE (src);
|
||
sets[i].mode = mode;
|
||
|
||
if (src_eqv)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode eqvmode = mode;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
eqvmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (dest, 0)));
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
src_eqv = fold_rtx (src_eqv, insn);
|
||
src_eqv_hash = HASH (src_eqv, eqvmode);
|
||
|
||
/* Find the equivalence class for the equivalent expression. */
|
||
|
||
if (!do_not_record)
|
||
src_eqv_elt = lookup (src_eqv, src_eqv_hash, eqvmode);
|
||
|
||
src_eqv_volatile = do_not_record;
|
||
src_eqv_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
src_eqv_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a STRICT_LOW_PART assignment, src_eqv corresponds to the
|
||
value of the INNER register, not the destination. So it is not
|
||
a legal substitution for the source. But save it for later. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
src_eqv_here = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
src_eqv_here = src_eqv;
|
||
|
||
/* Simplify and foldable subexpressions in SRC. Then get the fully-
|
||
simplified result, which may not necessarily be valid. */
|
||
src_folded = fold_rtx (src, insn);
|
||
|
||
/* If storing a constant in a bitfield, pre-truncate the constant
|
||
so we will be able to record it later. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
|
||
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx width = XEXP (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl), 1);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (width) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (width) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& (INTVAL (src) & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << INTVAL (width))))
|
||
src_folded
|
||
= GEN_INT (INTVAL (src) & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
|
||
<< INTVAL (width)) - 1));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute SRC's hash code, and also notice if it
|
||
should not be recorded at all. In that case,
|
||
prevent any further processing of this assignment. */
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
|
||
sets[i].src = src;
|
||
sets[i].src_hash = HASH (src, mode);
|
||
sets[i].src_volatile = do_not_record;
|
||
sets[i].src_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
sets[i].src_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* It is no longer clear why we used to do this, but it doesn't
|
||
appear to still be needed. So let's try without it since this
|
||
code hurts cse'ing widened ops. */
|
||
/* If source is a perverse subreg (such as QI treated as an SI),
|
||
treat it as volatile. It may do the work of an SI in one context
|
||
where the extra bits are not being used, but cannot replace an SI
|
||
in general. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src))
|
||
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src)))))
|
||
sets[i].src_volatile = 1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Locate all possible equivalent forms for SRC. Try to replace
|
||
SRC in the insn with each cheaper equivalent.
|
||
|
||
We have the following types of equivalents: SRC itself, a folded
|
||
version, a value given in a REG_EQUAL note, or a value related
|
||
to a constant.
|
||
|
||
Each of these equivalents may be part of an additional class
|
||
of equivalents (if more than one is in the table, they must be in
|
||
the same class; we check for this).
|
||
|
||
If the source is volatile, we don't do any table lookups.
|
||
|
||
We note any constant equivalent for possible later use in a
|
||
REG_NOTE. */
|
||
|
||
if (!sets[i].src_volatile)
|
||
elt = lookup (src, sets[i].src_hash, mode);
|
||
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = elt;
|
||
|
||
if (elt && src_eqv_here && src_eqv_elt)
|
||
{
|
||
if (elt->first_same_value != src_eqv_elt->first_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The REG_EQUAL is indicating that two formerly distinct
|
||
classes are now equivalent. So merge them. */
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (elt, src_eqv_elt);
|
||
src_eqv_hash = HASH (src_eqv, elt->mode);
|
||
src_eqv_elt = lookup (src_eqv, src_eqv_hash, elt->mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
src_eqv_here = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (src_eqv_elt)
|
||
elt = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Try to find a constant somewhere and record it in `src_const'.
|
||
Record its table element, if any, in `src_const_elt'. Look in
|
||
any known equivalences first. (If the constant is not in the
|
||
table, also set `sets[i].src_const_hash'). */
|
||
if (elt)
|
||
for (p = elt->first_same_value; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
if (p->is_const)
|
||
{
|
||
src_const = p->exp;
|
||
src_const_elt = elt;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_const == 0
|
||
&& (CONSTANT_P (src_folded)
|
||
/* Consider (minus (label_ref L1) (label_ref L2)) as
|
||
"constant" here so we will record it. This allows us
|
||
to fold switch statements when an ADDR_DIFF_VEC is used. */
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (src_folded) == MINUS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src_folded, 0)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src_folded, 1)) == LABEL_REF)))
|
||
src_const = src_folded, src_const_elt = elt;
|
||
else if (src_const == 0 && src_eqv_here && CONSTANT_P (src_eqv_here))
|
||
src_const = src_eqv_here, src_const_elt = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't know if the constant is in the table, get its
|
||
hash code and look it up. */
|
||
if (src_const && src_const_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
sets[i].src_const_hash = HASH (src_const, mode);
|
||
src_const_elt = lookup (src_const, sets[i].src_const_hash, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
sets[i].src_const = src_const;
|
||
sets[i].src_const_elt = src_const_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* If the constant and our source are both in the table, mark them as
|
||
equivalent. Otherwise, if a constant is in the table but the source
|
||
isn't, set ELT to it. */
|
||
if (src_const_elt && elt
|
||
&& src_const_elt->first_same_value != elt->first_same_value)
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (elt, src_const_elt);
|
||
else if (src_const_elt && elt == 0)
|
||
elt = src_const_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* See if there is a register linearly related to a constant
|
||
equivalent of SRC. */
|
||
if (src_const
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (src_const) == CONST
|
||
|| (src_const_elt && src_const_elt->related_value != 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
src_related = use_related_value (src_const, src_const_elt);
|
||
if (src_related)
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *src_related_elt
|
||
= lookup (src_related, HASH (src_related, mode), mode);
|
||
if (src_related_elt && elt)
|
||
{
|
||
if (elt->first_same_value
|
||
!= src_related_elt->first_same_value)
|
||
/* This can occur when we previously saw a CONST
|
||
involving a SYMBOL_REF and then see the SYMBOL_REF
|
||
twice. Merge the involved classes. */
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (elt, src_related_elt);
|
||
|
||
src_related = 0;
|
||
src_related_elt = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (src_related_elt && elt == 0)
|
||
elt = src_related_elt;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* See if we have a CONST_INT that is already in a register in a
|
||
wider mode. */
|
||
|
||
if (src_const && src_related == 0 && GET_CODE (src_const) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode wider_mode;
|
||
|
||
for (wider_mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wider_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& src_related == 0;
|
||
wider_mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (wider_mode))
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *const_elt
|
||
= lookup (src_const, HASH (src_const, wider_mode), wider_mode);
|
||
|
||
if (const_elt == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
for (const_elt = const_elt->first_same_value;
|
||
const_elt; const_elt = const_elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (const_elt->exp) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
src_related = gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode,
|
||
const_elt->exp);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Another possibility is that we have an AND with a constant in
|
||
a mode narrower than a word. If so, it might have been generated
|
||
as part of an "if" which would narrow the AND. If we already
|
||
have done the AND in a wider mode, we can use a SUBREG of that
|
||
value. */
|
||
|
||
if (flag_expensive_optimizations && ! src_related
|
||
&& GET_CODE (src) == AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode tmode;
|
||
rtx new_and = gen_rtx (AND, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx inner = gen_lowpart_if_possible (tmode, XEXP (src, 0));
|
||
struct table_elt *larger_elt;
|
||
|
||
if (inner)
|
||
{
|
||
PUT_MODE (new_and, tmode);
|
||
XEXP (new_and, 0) = inner;
|
||
larger_elt = lookup (new_and, HASH (new_and, tmode), tmode);
|
||
if (larger_elt == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
for (larger_elt = larger_elt->first_same_value;
|
||
larger_elt; larger_elt = larger_elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (larger_elt->exp) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
src_related
|
||
= gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode, larger_elt->exp);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_related)
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
|
||
/* See if a MEM has already been loaded with a widening operation;
|
||
if it has, we can use a subreg of that. Many CISC machines
|
||
also have such operations, but this is only likely to be
|
||
beneficial these machines. */
|
||
|
||
if (flag_expensive_optimizations && src_related == 0
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (src) == MEM && ! do_not_record
|
||
&& LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode) != NIL)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode tmode;
|
||
|
||
/* Set what we are trying to extend and the operation it might
|
||
have been extended with. */
|
||
PUT_CODE (memory_extend_rtx, LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode));
|
||
XEXP (memory_extend_rtx, 0) = src;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *larger_elt;
|
||
|
||
PUT_MODE (memory_extend_rtx, tmode);
|
||
larger_elt = lookup (memory_extend_rtx,
|
||
HASH (memory_extend_rtx, tmode), tmode);
|
||
if (larger_elt == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
for (larger_elt = larger_elt->first_same_value;
|
||
larger_elt; larger_elt = larger_elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (larger_elt->exp) == REG)
|
||
{
|
||
src_related = gen_lowpart_if_possible (mode,
|
||
larger_elt->exp);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_related)
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* LOAD_EXTEND_OP */
|
||
|
||
if (src == src_folded)
|
||
src_folded = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* At this point, ELT, if non-zero, points to a class of expressions
|
||
equivalent to the source of this SET and SRC, SRC_EQV, SRC_FOLDED,
|
||
and SRC_RELATED, if non-zero, each contain additional equivalent
|
||
expressions. Prune these latter expressions by deleting expressions
|
||
already in the equivalence class.
|
||
|
||
Check for an equivalent identical to the destination. If found,
|
||
this is the preferred equivalent since it will likely lead to
|
||
elimination of the insn. Indicate this by placing it in
|
||
`src_related'. */
|
||
|
||
if (elt) elt = elt->first_same_value;
|
||
for (p = elt; p; p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (p->exp);
|
||
|
||
/* If the expression is not valid, ignore it. Then we do not
|
||
have to check for validity below. In most cases, we can use
|
||
`rtx_equal_p', since canonicalization has already been done. */
|
||
if (code != REG && ! exp_equiv_p (p->exp, p->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (src && GET_CODE (src) == code && rtx_equal_p (src, p->exp))
|
||
src = 0;
|
||
else if (src_folded && GET_CODE (src_folded) == code
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (src_folded, p->exp))
|
||
src_folded = 0;
|
||
else if (src_eqv_here && GET_CODE (src_eqv_here) == code
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (src_eqv_here, p->exp))
|
||
src_eqv_here = 0;
|
||
else if (src_related && GET_CODE (src_related) == code
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (src_related, p->exp))
|
||
src_related = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* This is the same as the destination of the insns, we want
|
||
to prefer it. Copy it to src_related. The code below will
|
||
then give it a negative cost. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == code && rtx_equal_p (p->exp, dest))
|
||
src_related = dest;
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find the cheapest valid equivalent, trying all the available
|
||
possibilities. Prefer items not in the hash table to ones
|
||
that are when they are equal cost. Note that we can never
|
||
worsen an insn as the current contents will also succeed.
|
||
If we find an equivalent identical to the destination, use it as best,
|
||
since this insn will probably be eliminated in that case. */
|
||
if (src)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (src, dest))
|
||
src_cost = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
src_cost = COST (src);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_eqv_here)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (src_eqv_here, dest))
|
||
src_eqv_cost = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
src_eqv_cost = COST (src_eqv_here);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_folded)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (src_folded, dest))
|
||
src_folded_cost = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
src_folded_cost = COST (src_folded);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (src_related)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (src_related, dest))
|
||
src_related_cost = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
src_related_cost = COST (src_related);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this was an indirect jump insn, a known label will really be
|
||
cheaper even though it looks more expensive. */
|
||
if (dest == pc_rtx && src_const && GET_CODE (src_const) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
src_folded = src_const, src_folded_cost = -1;
|
||
|
||
/* Terminate loop when replacement made. This must terminate since
|
||
the current contents will be tested and will always be valid. */
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx trial;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip invalid entries. */
|
||
while (elt && GET_CODE (elt->exp) != REG
|
||
&& ! exp_equiv_p (elt->exp, elt->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
elt = elt->next_same_value;
|
||
|
||
if (elt) src_elt_cost = elt->cost;
|
||
|
||
/* Find cheapest and skip it for the next time. For items
|
||
of equal cost, use this order:
|
||
src_folded, src, src_eqv, src_related and hash table entry. */
|
||
if (src_folded_cost <= src_cost
|
||
&& src_folded_cost <= src_eqv_cost
|
||
&& src_folded_cost <= src_related_cost
|
||
&& src_folded_cost <= src_elt_cost)
|
||
{
|
||
trial = src_folded, src_folded_cost = 10000;
|
||
if (src_folded_force_flag)
|
||
trial = force_const_mem (mode, trial);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (src_cost <= src_eqv_cost
|
||
&& src_cost <= src_related_cost
|
||
&& src_cost <= src_elt_cost)
|
||
trial = src, src_cost = 10000;
|
||
else if (src_eqv_cost <= src_related_cost
|
||
&& src_eqv_cost <= src_elt_cost)
|
||
trial = copy_rtx (src_eqv_here), src_eqv_cost = 10000;
|
||
else if (src_related_cost <= src_elt_cost)
|
||
trial = copy_rtx (src_related), src_related_cost = 10000;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
trial = copy_rtx (elt->exp);
|
||
elt = elt->next_same_value;
|
||
src_elt_cost = 10000;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We don't normally have an insn matching (set (pc) (pc)), so
|
||
check for this separately here. We will delete such an
|
||
insn below.
|
||
|
||
Tablejump insns contain a USE of the table, so simply replacing
|
||
the operand with the constant won't match. This is simply an
|
||
unconditional branch, however, and is therefore valid. Just
|
||
insert the substitution here and we will delete and re-emit
|
||
the insn later. */
|
||
|
||
if (n_sets == 1 && dest == pc_rtx
|
||
&& (trial == pc_rtx
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (trial) == LABEL_REF
|
||
&& ! condjump_p (insn))))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If TRIAL is a label in front of a jump table, we are
|
||
really falling through the switch (this is how casesi
|
||
insns work), so we must branch around the table. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (trial) == CODE_LABEL
|
||
&& NEXT_INSN (trial) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (trial)) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (trial))) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (trial))) == ADDR_VEC))
|
||
|
||
trial = gen_rtx (LABEL_REF, Pmode, get_label_after (trial));
|
||
|
||
SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl) = trial;
|
||
cse_jumps_altered = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Look for a substitution that makes a valid insn. */
|
||
else if (validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), trial, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
/* The result of apply_change_group can be ignored; see
|
||
canon_reg. */
|
||
|
||
validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl),
|
||
canon_reg (SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), insn),
|
||
1);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we previously found constant pool entries for
|
||
constants and this is a constant, try making a
|
||
pool entry. Put it in src_folded unless we already have done
|
||
this since that is where it likely came from. */
|
||
|
||
else if (constant_pool_entries_cost
|
||
&& CONSTANT_P (trial)
|
||
&& ! (GET_CODE (trial) == CONST
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (trial, 0)) == TRUNCATE)
|
||
&& (src_folded == 0
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (src_folded) != MEM
|
||
&& ! src_folded_force_flag))
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
|
||
{
|
||
src_folded_force_flag = 1;
|
||
src_folded = trial;
|
||
src_folded_cost = constant_pool_entries_cost;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
src = SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* In general, it is good to have a SET with SET_SRC == SET_DEST.
|
||
However, there is an important exception: If both are registers
|
||
that are not the head of their equivalence class, replace SET_SRC
|
||
with the head of the class. If we do not do this, we will have
|
||
both registers live over a portion of the basic block. This way,
|
||
their lifetimes will likely abut instead of overlapping. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (dest))
|
||
&& qty_mode[reg_qty[REGNO (dest)]] == GET_MODE (dest)
|
||
&& qty_first_reg[reg_qty[REGNO (dest)]] != REGNO (dest)
|
||
&& GET_CODE (src) == REG && REGNO (src) == REGNO (dest)
|
||
/* Don't do this if the original insn had a hard reg as
|
||
SET_SRC. */
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (sets[i].src) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (sets[i].src) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
|
||
/* We can't call canon_reg here because it won't do anything if
|
||
SRC is a hard register. */
|
||
{
|
||
int first = qty_first_reg[reg_qty[REGNO (src)]];
|
||
|
||
src = SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl)
|
||
= first >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? regno_reg_rtx[first]
|
||
: gen_rtx (REG, GET_MODE (src), first);
|
||
|
||
/* If we had a constant that is cheaper than what we are now
|
||
setting SRC to, use that constant. We ignored it when we
|
||
thought we could make this into a no-op. */
|
||
if (src_const && COST (src_const) < COST (src)
|
||
&& validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), src_const, 0))
|
||
src = src_const;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we made a change, recompute SRC values. */
|
||
if (src != sets[i].src)
|
||
{
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_memory = 0;
|
||
hash_arg_in_struct = 0;
|
||
sets[i].src = src;
|
||
sets[i].src_hash = HASH (src, mode);
|
||
sets[i].src_volatile = do_not_record;
|
||
sets[i].src_in_memory = hash_arg_in_memory;
|
||
sets[i].src_in_struct = hash_arg_in_struct;
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = lookup (src, sets[i].src_hash, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a single SET, we are setting a register, and we have an
|
||
equivalent constant, we want to add a REG_NOTE. We don't want
|
||
to write a REG_EQUAL note for a constant pseudo since verifying that
|
||
that pseudo hasn't been eliminated is a pain. Such a note also
|
||
won't help anything. */
|
||
if (n_sets == 1 && src_const && GET_CODE (dest) == REG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (src_const) != REG)
|
||
{
|
||
tem = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
/* Record the actual constant value in a REG_EQUAL note, making
|
||
a new one if one does not already exist. */
|
||
if (tem)
|
||
XEXP (tem, 0) = src_const;
|
||
else
|
||
REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx (EXPR_LIST, REG_EQUAL,
|
||
src_const, REG_NOTES (insn));
|
||
|
||
/* If storing a constant value in a register that
|
||
previously held the constant value 0,
|
||
record this fact with a REG_WAS_0 note on this insn.
|
||
|
||
Note that the *register* is required to have previously held 0,
|
||
not just any register in the quantity and we must point to the
|
||
insn that set that register to zero.
|
||
|
||
Rather than track each register individually, we just see if
|
||
the last set for this quantity was for this register. */
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (dest))
|
||
&& qty_const[reg_qty[REGNO (dest)]] == const0_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* See if we previously had a REG_WAS_0 note. */
|
||
rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_WAS_0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
rtx const_insn = qty_const_insn[reg_qty[REGNO (dest)]];
|
||
|
||
if ((tem = single_set (const_insn)) != 0
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (tem), dest))
|
||
{
|
||
if (note)
|
||
XEXP (note, 0) = const_insn;
|
||
else
|
||
REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx (INSN_LIST, REG_WAS_0,
|
||
const_insn, REG_NOTES (insn));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now deal with the destination. */
|
||
do_not_record = 0;
|
||
sets[i].inner_dest_loc = &SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* Look within any SIGN_EXTRACT or ZERO_EXTRACT
|
||
to the MEM or REG within it. */
|
||
while (GET_CODE (dest) == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
{
|
||
sets[i].inner_dest_loc = &XEXP (dest, 0);
|
||
dest = XEXP (dest, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
sets[i].inner_dest = dest;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
dest = fold_rtx (dest, insn);
|
||
|
||
/* Decide whether we invalidate everything in memory,
|
||
or just things at non-fixed places.
|
||
Writing a large aggregate must invalidate everything
|
||
because we don't know how long it is. */
|
||
note_mem_written (dest, &writes_memory);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the hash code of the destination now,
|
||
before the effects of this instruction are recorded,
|
||
since the register values used in the address computation
|
||
are those before this instruction. */
|
||
sets[i].dest_hash = HASH (dest, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't enter a bit-field in the hash table
|
||
because the value in it after the store
|
||
may not equal what was stored, due to truncation. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
|
||
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx width = XEXP (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl), 1);
|
||
|
||
if (src_const != 0 && GET_CODE (src_const) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (width) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (width) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& ! (INTVAL (src_const)
|
||
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << INTVAL (width))))
|
||
/* Exception: if the value is constant,
|
||
and it won't be truncated, record it. */
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is chosen so that the destination will be invalidated
|
||
but no new value will be recorded.
|
||
We must invalidate because sometimes constant
|
||
values can be recorded for bitfields. */
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = 0;
|
||
sets[i].src_volatile = 1;
|
||
src_eqv = 0;
|
||
src_eqv_elt = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If only one set in a JUMP_INSN and it is now a no-op, we can delete
|
||
the insn. */
|
||
else if (n_sets == 1 && dest == pc_rtx && src == pc_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
|
||
NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
|
||
NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
|
||
cse_jumps_altered = 1;
|
||
/* One less use of the label this insn used to jump to. */
|
||
--LABEL_NUSES (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
|
||
/* No more processing for this set. */
|
||
sets[i].rtl = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this SET is now setting PC to a label, we know it used to
|
||
be a conditional or computed branch. So we see if we can follow
|
||
it. If it was a computed branch, delete it and re-emit. */
|
||
else if (dest == pc_rtx && GET_CODE (src) == LABEL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx p;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is not in the format for a simple branch and
|
||
we are the only SET in it, re-emit it. */
|
||
if (! simplejump_p (insn) && n_sets == 1)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new = emit_jump_insn_before (gen_jump (XEXP (src, 0)), insn);
|
||
JUMP_LABEL (new) = XEXP (src, 0);
|
||
LABEL_NUSES (XEXP (src, 0))++;
|
||
delete_insn (insn);
|
||
insn = new;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
/* Otherwise, force rerecognition, since it probably had
|
||
a different pattern before.
|
||
This shouldn't really be necessary, since whatever
|
||
changed the source value above should have done this.
|
||
Until the right place is found, might as well do this here. */
|
||
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
||
|
||
/* Now that we've converted this jump to an unconditional jump,
|
||
there is dead code after it. Delete the dead code until we
|
||
reach a BARRIER, the end of the function, or a label. Do
|
||
not delete NOTEs except for NOTE_INSN_DELETED since later
|
||
phases assume these notes are retained. */
|
||
|
||
p = insn;
|
||
|
||
while (NEXT_INSN (p) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (p)) != BARRIER
|
||
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (p)) != CODE_LABEL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (p)) != NOTE
|
||
|| NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (NEXT_INSN (p)) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED)
|
||
delete_insn (NEXT_INSN (p));
|
||
else
|
||
p = NEXT_INSN (p);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't have a BARRIER immediately after INSN, put one there.
|
||
Much code assumes that there are no NOTEs between a JUMP_INSN and
|
||
BARRIER. */
|
||
|
||
if (NEXT_INSN (insn) == 0
|
||
|| GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != BARRIER)
|
||
emit_barrier_after (insn);
|
||
|
||
/* We might have two BARRIERs separated by notes. Delete the second
|
||
one if so. */
|
||
|
||
if (p != insn && NEXT_INSN (p) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (p)) == BARRIER)
|
||
delete_insn (NEXT_INSN (p));
|
||
|
||
cse_jumps_altered = 1;
|
||
sets[i].rtl = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If destination is volatile, invalidate it and then do no further
|
||
processing for this assignment. */
|
||
|
||
else if (do_not_record)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG || GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
|
||
invalidate (dest, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (dest, 0), GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
sets[i].rtl = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl != 0 && dest != SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl))
|
||
sets[i].dest_hash = HASH (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl), mode);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
/* If setting CC0, record what it was set to, or a constant, if it
|
||
is equivalent to a constant. If it is being set to a floating-point
|
||
value, make a COMPARE with the appropriate constant of 0. If we
|
||
don't do this, later code can interpret this as a test against
|
||
const0_rtx, which can cause problems if we try to put it into an
|
||
insn as a floating-point operand. */
|
||
if (dest == cc0_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
this_insn_cc0 = src_const && mode != VOIDmode ? src_const : src;
|
||
this_insn_cc0_mode = mode;
|
||
if (FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
this_insn_cc0 = gen_rtx (COMPARE, VOIDmode, this_insn_cc0,
|
||
CONST0_RTX (mode));
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now enter all non-volatile source expressions in the hash table
|
||
if they are not already present.
|
||
Record their equivalence classes in src_elt.
|
||
This way we can insert the corresponding destinations into
|
||
the same classes even if the actual sources are no longer in them
|
||
(having been invalidated). */
|
||
|
||
if (src_eqv && src_eqv_elt == 0 && sets[0].rtl != 0 && ! src_eqv_volatile
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_p (src_eqv, SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl)))
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
register struct table_elt *classp = sets[0].src_elt;
|
||
rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl);
|
||
enum machine_mode eqvmode = GET_MODE (dest);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
{
|
||
eqvmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (dest, 0)));
|
||
classp = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
if (insert_regs (src_eqv, classp, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (src_eqv);
|
||
src_eqv_hash = HASH (src_eqv, eqvmode);
|
||
}
|
||
elt = insert (src_eqv, classp, src_eqv_hash, eqvmode);
|
||
elt->in_memory = src_eqv_in_memory;
|
||
elt->in_struct = src_eqv_in_struct;
|
||
src_eqv_elt = elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Check to see if src_eqv_elt is the same as a set source which
|
||
does not yet have an elt, and if so set the elt of the set source
|
||
to src_eqv_elt. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl && sets[i].src_elt == 0
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), src_eqv))
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl && ! sets[i].src_volatile
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (sets[i].rtl), SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
{
|
||
/* REG_EQUAL in setting a STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
gives an equivalent for the entire destination register,
|
||
not just for the subreg being stored in now.
|
||
This is a more interesting equivalence, so we arrange later
|
||
to treat the entire reg as the destination. */
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
sets[i].src_hash = src_eqv_hash;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Insert source and constant equivalent into hash table, if not
|
||
already present. */
|
||
register struct table_elt *classp = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
register rtx src = sets[i].src;
|
||
register rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
enum machine_mode mode
|
||
= GET_MODE (src) == VOIDmode ? GET_MODE (dest) : GET_MODE (src);
|
||
|
||
if (sets[i].src_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Note that these insert_regs calls cannot remove
|
||
any of the src_elt's, because they would have failed to
|
||
match if not still valid. */
|
||
if (insert_regs (src, classp, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (src);
|
||
sets[i].src_hash = HASH (src, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
elt = insert (src, classp, sets[i].src_hash, mode);
|
||
elt->in_memory = sets[i].src_in_memory;
|
||
elt->in_struct = sets[i].src_in_struct;
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = classp = elt;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (sets[i].src_const && sets[i].src_const_elt == 0
|
||
&& src != sets[i].src_const
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_p (sets[i].src_const, src))
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = insert (sets[i].src_const, classp,
|
||
sets[i].src_const_hash, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (sets[i].src_elt == 0)
|
||
/* If we did not insert the source into the hash table (e.g., it was
|
||
volatile), note the equivalence class for the REG_EQUAL value, if any,
|
||
so that the destination goes into that class. */
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = src_eqv_elt;
|
||
|
||
invalidate_from_clobbers (&writes_memory, x);
|
||
|
||
/* Some registers are invalidated by subroutine calls. Memory is
|
||
invalidated by non-constant calls. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
||
{
|
||
static struct write_data everything = {0, 1, 1, 1};
|
||
|
||
if (! CONST_CALL_P (insn))
|
||
invalidate_memory (&everything);
|
||
invalidate_for_call ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now invalidate everything set by this instruction.
|
||
If a SUBREG or other funny destination is being set,
|
||
sets[i].rtl is still nonzero, so here we invalidate the reg
|
||
a part of which is being set. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We can't use the inner dest, because the mode associated with
|
||
a ZERO_EXTRACT is significant. */
|
||
register rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* Needed for registers to remove the register from its
|
||
previous quantity's chain.
|
||
Needed for memory if this is a nonvarying address, unless
|
||
we have just done an invalidate_memory that covers even those. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG || GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM && ! writes_memory.all
|
||
&& ! cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (dest)))
|
||
invalidate (dest, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (dest, 0), GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure registers mentioned in destinations
|
||
are safe for use in an expression to be inserted.
|
||
This removes from the hash table
|
||
any invalid entry that refers to one of these registers.
|
||
|
||
We don't care about the return value from mention_regs because
|
||
we are going to hash the SET_DEST values unconditionally. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl)) != REG)
|
||
mention_regs (SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl));
|
||
|
||
/* We may have just removed some of the src_elt's from the hash table.
|
||
So replace each one with the current head of the same class. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
if (sets[i].src_elt && sets[i].src_elt->first_same_value == 0)
|
||
/* If elt was removed, find current head of same class,
|
||
or 0 if nothing remains of that class. */
|
||
{
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt = sets[i].src_elt;
|
||
|
||
while (elt && elt->prev_same_value)
|
||
elt = elt->prev_same_value;
|
||
|
||
while (elt && elt->first_same_value == 0)
|
||
elt = elt->next_same_value;
|
||
sets[i].src_elt = elt ? elt->first_same_value : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now insert the destinations into their equivalence classes. */
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_sets; i++)
|
||
if (sets[i].rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl);
|
||
register struct table_elt *elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't record value if we are not supposed to risk allocating
|
||
floating-point values in registers that might be wider than
|
||
memory. */
|
||
if ((flag_float_store
|
||
&& GET_CODE (dest) == MEM
|
||
&& FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest)))
|
||
/* Don't record values of destinations set inside a libcall block
|
||
since we might delete the libcall. Things should have been set
|
||
up so we won't want to reuse such a value, but we play it safe
|
||
here. */
|
||
|| in_libcall_block
|
||
/* If we didn't put a REG_EQUAL value or a source into the hash
|
||
table, there is no point is recording DEST. */
|
||
|| sets[i].src_elt == 0
|
||
/* If DEST is a paradoxical SUBREG and SRC is a ZERO_EXTEND
|
||
or SIGN_EXTEND, don't record DEST since it can cause
|
||
some tracking to be wrong.
|
||
|
||
??? Think about this more later. */
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest))
|
||
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest))))
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (sets[i].src) == SIGN_EXTEND
|
||
|| GET_CODE (sets[i].src) == ZERO_EXTEND)))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
/* STRICT_LOW_PART isn't part of the value BEING set,
|
||
and neither is the SUBREG inside it.
|
||
Note that in this case SETS[I].SRC_ELT is really SRC_EQV_ELT. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
||
dest = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (dest, 0));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG || GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
|
||
/* Registers must also be inserted into chains for quantities. */
|
||
if (insert_regs (dest, sets[i].src_elt, 1))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If `insert_regs' changes something, the hash code must be
|
||
recalculated. */
|
||
rehash_using_reg (dest);
|
||
sets[i].dest_hash = HASH (dest, GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
elt = insert (dest, sets[i].src_elt,
|
||
sets[i].dest_hash, GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
elt->in_memory = GET_CODE (sets[i].inner_dest) == MEM;
|
||
if (elt->in_memory)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This implicitly assumes a whole struct
|
||
need not have MEM_IN_STRUCT_P.
|
||
But a whole struct is *supposed* to have MEM_IN_STRUCT_P. */
|
||
elt->in_struct = (MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (sets[i].inner_dest)
|
||
|| sets[i].inner_dest != SET_DEST (sets[i].rtl));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we have (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 foo) 0) (bar:m1)), M1 is no
|
||
narrower than M2, and both M1 and M2 are the same number of words,
|
||
we are also doing (set (reg:m2 foo) (subreg:m2 (bar:m1) 0)) so
|
||
make that equivalence as well.
|
||
|
||
However, BAR may have equivalences for which gen_lowpart_if_possible
|
||
will produce a simpler value than gen_lowpart_if_possible applied to
|
||
BAR (e.g., if BAR was ZERO_EXTENDed from M2), so we will scan all
|
||
BAR's equivalences. If we don't get a simplified form, make
|
||
the SUBREG. It will not be used in an equivalence, but will
|
||
cause two similar assignments to be detected.
|
||
|
||
Note the loop below will find SUBREG_REG (DEST) since we have
|
||
already entered SRC and DEST of the SET in the table. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
&& (((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest))) - 1)
|
||
/ UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
== (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) - 1)/ UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest))
|
||
>= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest))))
|
||
&& sets[i].src_elt != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode new_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest));
|
||
struct table_elt *elt, *classp = 0;
|
||
|
||
for (elt = sets[i].src_elt->first_same_value; elt;
|
||
elt = elt->next_same_value)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new_src = 0;
|
||
unsigned src_hash;
|
||
struct table_elt *src_elt;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore invalid entries. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (elt->exp) != REG
|
||
&& ! exp_equiv_p (elt->exp, elt->exp, 1, 0))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
new_src = gen_lowpart_if_possible (new_mode, elt->exp);
|
||
if (new_src == 0)
|
||
new_src = gen_rtx (SUBREG, new_mode, elt->exp, 0);
|
||
|
||
src_hash = HASH (new_src, new_mode);
|
||
src_elt = lookup (new_src, src_hash, new_mode);
|
||
|
||
/* Put the new source in the hash table is if isn't
|
||
already. */
|
||
if (src_elt == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (insert_regs (new_src, classp, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rehash_using_reg (new_src);
|
||
src_hash = HASH (new_src, new_mode);
|
||
}
|
||
src_elt = insert (new_src, classp, src_hash, new_mode);
|
||
src_elt->in_memory = elt->in_memory;
|
||
src_elt->in_struct = elt->in_struct;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (classp && classp != src_elt->first_same_value)
|
||
/* Show that two things that we've seen before are
|
||
actually the same. */
|
||
merge_equiv_classes (src_elt, classp);
|
||
|
||
classp = src_elt->first_same_value;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Special handling for (set REG0 REG1)
|
||
where REG0 is the "cheapest", cheaper than REG1.
|
||
After cse, REG1 will probably not be used in the sequel,
|
||
so (if easily done) change this insn to (set REG1 REG0) and
|
||
replace REG1 with REG0 in the previous insn that computed their value.
|
||
Then REG1 will become a dead store and won't cloud the situation
|
||
for later optimizations.
|
||
|
||
Do not make this change if REG1 is a hard register, because it will
|
||
then be used in the sequel and we may be changing a two-operand insn
|
||
into a three-operand insn.
|
||
|
||
Also do not do this if we are operating on a copy of INSN. */
|
||
|
||
if (n_sets == 1 && sets[0].rtl && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl)) == REG
|
||
&& NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) == insn
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl)))
|
||
&& (qty_first_reg[reg_qty[REGNO (SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl))]]
|
||
== REGNO (SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl))))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
||
while (prev && GET_CODE (prev) == NOTE)
|
||
prev = PREV_INSN (prev);
|
||
|
||
if (prev && GET_CODE (prev) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
|
||
&& SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)) == SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx dest = SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl);
|
||
rtx note = find_reg_note (prev, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
validate_change (prev, & SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), dest, 1);
|
||
validate_change (insn, & SET_DEST (sets[0].rtl),
|
||
SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl), 1);
|
||
validate_change (insn, & SET_SRC (sets[0].rtl), dest, 1);
|
||
apply_change_group ();
|
||
|
||
/* If REG1 was equivalent to a constant, REG0 is not. */
|
||
if (note)
|
||
PUT_REG_NOTE_KIND (note, REG_EQUAL);
|
||
|
||
/* If there was a REG_WAS_0 note on PREV, remove it. Move
|
||
any REG_WAS_0 note on INSN to PREV. */
|
||
note = find_reg_note (prev, REG_WAS_0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (note)
|
||
remove_note (prev, note);
|
||
|
||
note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_WAS_0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (note)
|
||
{
|
||
remove_note (insn, note);
|
||
XEXP (note, 1) = REG_NOTES (prev);
|
||
REG_NOTES (prev) = note;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a conditional jump insn, record any known equivalences due to
|
||
the condition being tested. */
|
||
|
||
last_jump_equiv_class = 0;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& n_sets == 1 && GET_CODE (x) == SET
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == IF_THEN_ELSE)
|
||
record_jump_equiv (insn, 0);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
/* If the previous insn set CC0 and this insn no longer references CC0,
|
||
delete the previous insn. Here we use the fact that nothing expects CC0
|
||
to be valid over an insn, which is true until the final pass. */
|
||
if (prev_insn && GET_CODE (prev_insn) == INSN
|
||
&& (tem = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
|
||
&& SET_DEST (tem) == cc0_rtx
|
||
&& ! reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, x))
|
||
{
|
||
PUT_CODE (prev_insn, NOTE);
|
||
NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
|
||
NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (prev_insn) = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
prev_insn_cc0 = this_insn_cc0;
|
||
prev_insn_cc0_mode = this_insn_cc0_mode;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
prev_insn = insn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store 1 in *WRITES_PTR for those categories of memory ref
|
||
that must be invalidated when the expression WRITTEN is stored in.
|
||
If WRITTEN is null, say everything must be invalidated. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
note_mem_written (written, writes_ptr)
|
||
rtx written;
|
||
struct write_data *writes_ptr;
|
||
{
|
||
static struct write_data everything = {0, 1, 1, 1};
|
||
|
||
if (written == 0)
|
||
*writes_ptr = everything;
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (written) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Pushing or popping the stack invalidates just the stack pointer. */
|
||
rtx addr = XEXP (written, 0);
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (addr) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC)
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
{
|
||
writes_ptr->sp = 1;
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (written) == BLKmode)
|
||
*writes_ptr = everything;
|
||
/* (mem (scratch)) means clobber everything. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SCRATCH)
|
||
*writes_ptr = everything;
|
||
else if (cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (written))
|
||
{
|
||
/* A varying address that is a sum indicates an array element,
|
||
and that's just as good as a structure element
|
||
in implying that we need not invalidate scalar variables.
|
||
However, we must allow QImode aliasing of scalars, because the
|
||
ANSI C standard allows character pointers to alias anything. */
|
||
if (! ((MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (written)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (written, 0)) == PLUS)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (written) != QImode))
|
||
writes_ptr->all = 1;
|
||
writes_ptr->nonscalar = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
writes_ptr->var = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Perform invalidation on the basis of everything about an insn
|
||
except for invalidating the actual places that are SET in it.
|
||
This includes the places CLOBBERed, and anything that might
|
||
alias with something that is SET or CLOBBERed.
|
||
|
||
W points to the writes_memory for this insn, a struct write_data
|
||
saying which kinds of memory references must be invalidated.
|
||
X is the pattern of the insn. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate_from_clobbers (w, x)
|
||
struct write_data *w;
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
{
|
||
/* If W->var is not set, W specifies no action.
|
||
If W->all is set, this step gets all memory refs
|
||
so they can be ignored in the rest of this function. */
|
||
if (w->var)
|
||
invalidate_memory (w);
|
||
|
||
if (w->sp)
|
||
{
|
||
if (reg_tick[STACK_POINTER_REGNUM] >= 0)
|
||
reg_tick[STACK_POINTER_REGNUM]++;
|
||
|
||
/* This should be *very* rare. */
|
||
if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (hard_regs_in_table, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM))
|
||
invalidate (stack_pointer_rtx, VOIDmode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ref = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
if (ref)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (ref) == REG || GET_CODE (ref) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (ref) == MEM && ! w->all))
|
||
invalidate (ref, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (ref) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (ref) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (ref, 0), GET_MODE (ref));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
|
||
{
|
||
register int i;
|
||
for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx y = XVECEXP (x, 0, i);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (y) == CLOBBER)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ref = XEXP (y, 0);
|
||
if (ref)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (ref) == REG || GET_CODE (ref) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (ref) == MEM && !w->all))
|
||
invalidate (ref, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (ref) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (ref) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (ref, 0), GET_MODE (ref));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Process X, part of the REG_NOTES of an insn. Look at any REG_EQUAL notes
|
||
and replace any registers in them with either an equivalent constant
|
||
or the canonical form of the register. If we are inside an address,
|
||
only do this if the address remains valid.
|
||
|
||
OBJECT is 0 except when within a MEM in which case it is the MEM.
|
||
|
||
Return the replacement for X. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
cse_process_notes (x, object)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
rtx object;
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
|
||
char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
case PC:
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
case LO_SUM:
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
XEXP (x, 0) = cse_process_notes (XEXP (x, 0), x);
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
case EXPR_LIST:
|
||
case INSN_LIST:
|
||
if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_EQUAL)
|
||
XEXP (x, 0) = cse_process_notes (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (XEXP (x, 1))
|
||
XEXP (x, 1) = cse_process_notes (XEXP (x, 1), NULL_RTX);
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
case SIGN_EXTEND:
|
||
case ZERO_EXTEND:
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new = cse_process_notes (XEXP (x, 0), object);
|
||
/* We don't substitute VOIDmode constants into these rtx,
|
||
since they would impede folding. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE (new) != VOIDmode)
|
||
validate_change (object, &XEXP (x, 0), new, 0);
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case REG:
|
||
i = reg_qty[REGNO (x)];
|
||
|
||
/* Return a constant or a constant register. */
|
||
if (REGNO_QTY_VALID_P (REGNO (x))
|
||
&& qty_const[i] != 0
|
||
&& (CONSTANT_P (qty_const[i])
|
||
|| GET_CODE (qty_const[i]) == REG))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new = gen_lowpart_if_possible (GET_MODE (x), qty_const[i]);
|
||
if (new)
|
||
return new;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, canonicalize this register. */
|
||
return canon_reg (x, NULL_RTX);
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++)
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
validate_change (object, &XEXP (x, i),
|
||
cse_process_notes (XEXP (x, i), object), 0);
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find common subexpressions between the end test of a loop and the beginning
|
||
of the loop. LOOP_START is the CODE_LABEL at the start of a loop.
|
||
|
||
Often we have a loop where an expression in the exit test is used
|
||
in the body of the loop. For example "while (*p) *q++ = *p++;".
|
||
Because of the way we duplicate the loop exit test in front of the loop,
|
||
however, we don't detect that common subexpression. This will be caught
|
||
when global cse is implemented, but this is a quite common case.
|
||
|
||
This function handles the most common cases of these common expressions.
|
||
It is called after we have processed the basic block ending with the
|
||
NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END note that ends a loop and the previous JUMP_INSN
|
||
jumps to a label used only once. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
cse_around_loop (loop_start)
|
||
rtx loop_start;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
int i;
|
||
struct table_elt *p;
|
||
|
||
/* If the jump at the end of the loop doesn't go to the start, we don't
|
||
do anything. */
|
||
for (insn = PREV_INSN (loop_start);
|
||
insn && (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) >= 0);
|
||
insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
if (insn == 0
|
||
|| GET_CODE (insn) != NOTE
|
||
|| NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) != NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If the last insn of the loop (the end test) was an NE comparison,
|
||
we will interpret it as an EQ comparison, since we fell through
|
||
the loop. Any equivalences resulting from that comparison are
|
||
therefore not valid and must be invalidated. */
|
||
if (last_jump_equiv_class)
|
||
for (p = last_jump_equiv_class->first_same_value; p;
|
||
p = p->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == MEM || GET_CODE (p->exp) == REG
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (p->exp) == SUBREG
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (p->exp)) == REG))
|
||
invalidate (p->exp, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (p->exp) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (p->exp) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (p->exp, 0), GET_MODE (p->exp));
|
||
|
||
/* Process insns starting after LOOP_START until we hit a CALL_INSN or
|
||
a CODE_LABEL (we could handle a CALL_INSN, but it isn't worth it).
|
||
|
||
The only thing we do with SET_DEST is invalidate entries, so we
|
||
can safely process each SET in order. It is slightly less efficient
|
||
to do so, but we only want to handle the most common cases. */
|
||
|
||
for (insn = NEXT_INSN (loop_start);
|
||
GET_CODE (insn) != CALL_INSN && GET_CODE (insn) != CODE_LABEL
|
||
&& ! (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
|
||
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END);
|
||
insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i'
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
|
||
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER))
|
||
cse_set_around_loop (PATTERN (insn), insn, loop_start);
|
||
else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i'
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL)
|
||
for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
|
||
cse_set_around_loop (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i), insn,
|
||
loop_start);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Variable used for communications between the next two routines. */
|
||
|
||
static struct write_data skipped_writes_memory;
|
||
|
||
/* Process one SET of an insn that was skipped. We ignore CLOBBERs
|
||
since they are done elsewhere. This function is called via note_stores. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate_skipped_set (dest, set)
|
||
rtx set;
|
||
rtx dest;
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (set) == CLOBBER
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
|| dest == cc0_rtx
|
||
#endif
|
||
|| dest == pc_rtx)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
|
||
note_mem_written (dest, &skipped_writes_memory);
|
||
|
||
/* There are times when an address can appear varying and be a PLUS
|
||
during this scan when it would be a fixed address were we to know
|
||
the proper equivalences. So promote "nonscalar" to be "all". */
|
||
if (skipped_writes_memory.nonscalar)
|
||
skipped_writes_memory.all = 1;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG || GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (! skipped_writes_memory.all && ! cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (dest)))
|
||
invalidate (dest, VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (dest, 0), GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Invalidate all insns from START up to the end of the function or the
|
||
next label. This called when we wish to CSE around a block that is
|
||
conditionally executed. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
invalidate_skipped_block (start)
|
||
rtx start;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
static struct write_data init = {0, 0, 0, 0};
|
||
static struct write_data everything = {0, 1, 1, 1};
|
||
|
||
for (insn = start; insn && GET_CODE (insn) != CODE_LABEL;
|
||
insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) != 'i')
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
skipped_writes_memory = init;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
||
{
|
||
invalidate_for_call ();
|
||
skipped_writes_memory = everything;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
note_stores (PATTERN (insn), invalidate_skipped_set);
|
||
invalidate_from_clobbers (&skipped_writes_memory, PATTERN (insn));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Used for communication between the following two routines; contains a
|
||
value to be checked for modification. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx cse_check_loop_start_value;
|
||
|
||
/* If modifying X will modify the value in CSE_CHECK_LOOP_START_VALUE,
|
||
indicate that fact by setting CSE_CHECK_LOOP_START_VALUE to 0. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
cse_check_loop_start (x, set)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
rtx set;
|
||
{
|
||
if (cse_check_loop_start_value == 0
|
||
|| GET_CODE (x) == CC0 || GET_CODE (x) == PC)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (cse_check_loop_start_value) == MEM)
|
||
|| reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, cse_check_loop_start_value))
|
||
cse_check_loop_start_value = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* X is a SET or CLOBBER contained in INSN that was found near the start of
|
||
a loop that starts with the label at LOOP_START.
|
||
|
||
If X is a SET, we see if its SET_SRC is currently in our hash table.
|
||
If so, we see if it has a value equal to some register used only in the
|
||
loop exit code (as marked by jump.c).
|
||
|
||
If those two conditions are true, we search backwards from the start of
|
||
the loop to see if that same value was loaded into a register that still
|
||
retains its value at the start of the loop.
|
||
|
||
If so, we insert an insn after the load to copy the destination of that
|
||
load into the equivalent register and (try to) replace our SET_SRC with that
|
||
register.
|
||
|
||
In any event, we invalidate whatever this SET or CLOBBER modifies. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
cse_set_around_loop (x, insn, loop_start)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
rtx loop_start;
|
||
{
|
||
struct table_elt *src_elt;
|
||
static struct write_data init = {0, 0, 0, 0};
|
||
struct write_data writes_memory;
|
||
|
||
writes_memory = init;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a SET, see if we can replace SET_SRC, but ignore SETs that
|
||
are setting PC or CC0 or whose SET_SRC is already a register. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SET
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) != PC && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) != CC0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != REG)
|
||
{
|
||
src_elt = lookup (SET_SRC (x),
|
||
HASH (SET_SRC (x), GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x))),
|
||
GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)));
|
||
|
||
if (src_elt)
|
||
for (src_elt = src_elt->first_same_value; src_elt;
|
||
src_elt = src_elt->next_same_value)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src_elt->exp) == REG && REG_LOOP_TEST_P (src_elt->exp)
|
||
&& COST (src_elt->exp) < COST (SET_SRC (x)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx p, set;
|
||
|
||
/* Look for an insn in front of LOOP_START that sets
|
||
something in the desired mode to SET_SRC (x) before we hit
|
||
a label or CALL_INSN. */
|
||
|
||
for (p = prev_nonnote_insn (loop_start);
|
||
p && GET_CODE (p) != CALL_INSN
|
||
&& GET_CODE (p) != CODE_LABEL;
|
||
p = prev_nonnote_insn (p))
|
||
if ((set = single_set (p)) != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
|
||
&& GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)) == src_elt->mode
|
||
&& rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), SET_SRC (x)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We now have to ensure that nothing between P
|
||
and LOOP_START modified anything referenced in
|
||
SET_SRC (x). We know that nothing within the loop
|
||
can modify it, or we would have invalidated it in
|
||
the hash table. */
|
||
rtx q;
|
||
|
||
cse_check_loop_start_value = SET_SRC (x);
|
||
for (q = p; q != loop_start; q = NEXT_INSN (q))
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (q)) == 'i')
|
||
note_stores (PATTERN (q), cse_check_loop_start);
|
||
|
||
/* If nothing was changed and we can replace our
|
||
SET_SRC, add an insn after P to copy its destination
|
||
to what we will be replacing SET_SRC with. */
|
||
if (cse_check_loop_start_value
|
||
&& validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (x),
|
||
src_elt->exp, 0))
|
||
emit_insn_after (gen_move_insn (src_elt->exp,
|
||
SET_DEST (set)),
|
||
p);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now invalidate anything modified by X. */
|
||
note_mem_written (SET_DEST (x), &writes_memory);
|
||
|
||
if (writes_memory.var)
|
||
invalidate_memory (&writes_memory);
|
||
|
||
/* See comment on similar code in cse_insn for explanation of these tests. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == MEM && ! writes_memory.all
|
||
&& ! cse_rtx_addr_varies_p (SET_DEST (x))))
|
||
invalidate (SET_DEST (x), VOIDmode);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
||
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
||
invalidate (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0), GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find the end of INSN's basic block and return its range,
|
||
the total number of SETs in all the insns of the block, the last insn of the
|
||
block, and the branch path.
|
||
|
||
The branch path indicates which branches should be followed. If a non-zero
|
||
path size is specified, the block should be rescanned and a different set
|
||
of branches will be taken. The branch path is only used if
|
||
FLAG_CSE_FOLLOW_JUMPS or FLAG_CSE_SKIP_BLOCKS is non-zero.
|
||
|
||
DATA is a pointer to a struct cse_basic_block_data, defined below, that is
|
||
used to describe the block. It is filled in with the information about
|
||
the current block. The incoming structure's branch path, if any, is used
|
||
to construct the output branch path. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
cse_end_of_basic_block (insn, data, follow_jumps, after_loop, skip_blocks)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
struct cse_basic_block_data *data;
|
||
int follow_jumps;
|
||
int after_loop;
|
||
int skip_blocks;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx p = insn, q;
|
||
int nsets = 0;
|
||
int low_cuid = INSN_CUID (insn), high_cuid = INSN_CUID (insn);
|
||
rtx next = GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i' ? insn : next_real_insn (insn);
|
||
int path_size = data->path_size;
|
||
int path_entry = 0;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
/* Update the previous branch path, if any. If the last branch was
|
||
previously TAKEN, mark it NOT_TAKEN. If it was previously NOT_TAKEN,
|
||
shorten the path by one and look at the previous branch. We know that
|
||
at least one branch must have been taken if PATH_SIZE is non-zero. */
|
||
while (path_size > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (data->path[path_size - 1].status != NOT_TAKEN)
|
||
{
|
||
data->path[path_size - 1].status = NOT_TAKEN;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
path_size--;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Scan to end of this basic block. */
|
||
while (p && GET_CODE (p) != CODE_LABEL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Don't cse out the end of a loop. This makes a difference
|
||
only for the unusual loops that always execute at least once;
|
||
all other loops have labels there so we will stop in any case.
|
||
Cse'ing out the end of the loop is dangerous because it
|
||
might cause an invariant expression inside the loop
|
||
to be reused after the end of the loop. This would make it
|
||
hard to move the expression out of the loop in loop.c,
|
||
especially if it is one of several equivalent expressions
|
||
and loop.c would like to eliminate it.
|
||
|
||
If we are running after loop.c has finished, we can ignore
|
||
the NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END. */
|
||
|
||
if (! after_loop && GET_CODE (p) == NOTE
|
||
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (p) == NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't cse over a call to setjmp; on some machines (eg vax)
|
||
the regs restored by the longjmp come from
|
||
a later time than the setjmp. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (p) == NOTE
|
||
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (p) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* A PARALLEL can have lots of SETs in it,
|
||
especially if it is really an ASM_OPERANDS. */
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p)) == 'i'
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) == PARALLEL)
|
||
nsets += XVECLEN (PATTERN (p), 0);
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (p) != NOTE)
|
||
nsets += 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore insns made by CSE; they cannot affect the boundaries of
|
||
the basic block. */
|
||
|
||
if (INSN_UID (p) <= max_uid && INSN_CUID (p) > high_cuid)
|
||
high_cuid = INSN_CUID (p);
|
||
if (INSN_UID (p) <= max_uid && INSN_CUID (p) < low_cuid)
|
||
low_cuid = INSN_CUID (p);
|
||
|
||
/* See if this insn is in our branch path. If it is and we are to
|
||
take it, do so. */
|
||
if (path_entry < path_size && data->path[path_entry].branch == p)
|
||
{
|
||
if (data->path[path_entry].status != NOT_TAKEN)
|
||
p = JUMP_LABEL (p);
|
||
|
||
/* Point to next entry in path, if any. */
|
||
path_entry++;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a conditional jump, we can follow it if -fcse-follow-jumps
|
||
was specified, we haven't reached our maximum path length, there are
|
||
insns following the target of the jump, this is the only use of the
|
||
jump label, and the target label is preceded by a BARRIER.
|
||
|
||
Alternatively, we can follow the jump if it branches around a
|
||
block of code and there are no other branches into the block.
|
||
In this case invalidate_skipped_block will be called to invalidate any
|
||
registers set in the block when following the jump. */
|
||
|
||
else if ((follow_jumps || skip_blocks) && path_size < PATHLENGTH - 1
|
||
&& GET_CODE (p) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) == SET
|
||
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (p))) == IF_THEN_ELSE
|
||
&& LABEL_NUSES (JUMP_LABEL (p)) == 1
|
||
&& NEXT_INSN (JUMP_LABEL (p)) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
for (q = PREV_INSN (JUMP_LABEL (p)); q; q = PREV_INSN (q))
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (q) != NOTE
|
||
|| NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (q) == NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END
|
||
|| NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (q) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (q) != CODE_LABEL || LABEL_NUSES (q) != 0))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* If we ran into a BARRIER, this code is an extension of the
|
||
basic block when the branch is taken. */
|
||
if (follow_jumps && q != 0 && GET_CODE (q) == BARRIER)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Don't allow ourself to keep walking around an
|
||
always-executed loop. */
|
||
if (next_real_insn (q) == next)
|
||
{
|
||
p = NEXT_INSN (p);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Similarly, don't put a branch in our path more than once. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < path_entry; i++)
|
||
if (data->path[i].branch == p)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (i != path_entry)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
data->path[path_entry].branch = p;
|
||
data->path[path_entry++].status = TAKEN;
|
||
|
||
/* This branch now ends our path. It was possible that we
|
||
didn't see this branch the last time around (when the
|
||
insn in front of the target was a JUMP_INSN that was
|
||
turned into a no-op). */
|
||
path_size = path_entry;
|
||
|
||
p = JUMP_LABEL (p);
|
||
/* Mark block so we won't scan it again later. */
|
||
PUT_MODE (NEXT_INSN (p), QImode);
|
||
}
|
||
/* Detect a branch around a block of code. */
|
||
else if (skip_blocks && q != 0 && GET_CODE (q) != CODE_LABEL)
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx tmp;
|
||
|
||
if (next_real_insn (q) == next)
|
||
{
|
||
p = NEXT_INSN (p);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < path_entry; i++)
|
||
if (data->path[i].branch == p)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (i != path_entry)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* This is no_labels_between_p (p, q) with an added check for
|
||
reaching the end of a function (in case Q precedes P). */
|
||
for (tmp = NEXT_INSN (p); tmp && tmp != q; tmp = NEXT_INSN (tmp))
|
||
if (GET_CODE (tmp) == CODE_LABEL)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (tmp == q)
|
||
{
|
||
data->path[path_entry].branch = p;
|
||
data->path[path_entry++].status = AROUND;
|
||
|
||
path_size = path_entry;
|
||
|
||
p = JUMP_LABEL (p);
|
||
/* Mark block so we won't scan it again later. */
|
||
PUT_MODE (NEXT_INSN (p), QImode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
p = NEXT_INSN (p);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
data->low_cuid = low_cuid;
|
||
data->high_cuid = high_cuid;
|
||
data->nsets = nsets;
|
||
data->last = p;
|
||
|
||
/* If all jumps in the path are not taken, set our path length to zero
|
||
so a rescan won't be done. */
|
||
for (i = path_size - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (data->path[i].status != NOT_TAKEN)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (i == -1)
|
||
data->path_size = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
data->path_size = path_size;
|
||
|
||
/* End the current branch path. */
|
||
data->path[path_size].branch = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Perform cse on the instructions of a function.
|
||
F is the first instruction.
|
||
NREGS is one plus the highest pseudo-reg number used in the instruction.
|
||
|
||
AFTER_LOOP is 1 if this is the cse call done after loop optimization
|
||
(only if -frerun-cse-after-loop).
|
||
|
||
Returns 1 if jump_optimize should be redone due to simplifications
|
||
in conditional jump instructions. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
cse_main (f, nregs, after_loop, file)
|
||
rtx f;
|
||
int nregs;
|
||
int after_loop;
|
||
FILE *file;
|
||
{
|
||
struct cse_basic_block_data val;
|
||
register rtx insn = f;
|
||
register int i;
|
||
|
||
cse_jumps_altered = 0;
|
||
constant_pool_entries_cost = 0;
|
||
val.path_size = 0;
|
||
|
||
init_recog ();
|
||
|
||
max_reg = nregs;
|
||
|
||
all_minus_one = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
consec_ints = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
all_minus_one[i] = -1;
|
||
consec_ints[i] = i;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
reg_next_eqv = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
reg_prev_eqv = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
reg_qty = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
reg_in_table = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
reg_tick = (int *) alloca (nregs * sizeof (int));
|
||
|
||
#ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate scratch rtl here. cse_insn will fill in the memory reference
|
||
and change the code and mode as appropriate. */
|
||
memory_extend_rtx = gen_rtx (ZERO_EXTEND, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Discard all the free elements of the previous function
|
||
since they are allocated in the temporarily obstack. */
|
||
bzero ((char *) table, sizeof table);
|
||
free_element_chain = 0;
|
||
n_elements_made = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the largest uid. */
|
||
|
||
max_uid = get_max_uid ();
|
||
uid_cuid = (int *) alloca ((max_uid + 1) * sizeof (int));
|
||
bzero ((char *) uid_cuid, (max_uid + 1) * sizeof (int));
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the mapping from uids to cuids.
|
||
CUIDs are numbers assigned to insns, like uids,
|
||
except that cuids increase monotonically through the code.
|
||
Don't assign cuids to line-number NOTEs, so that the distance in cuids
|
||
between two insns is not affected by -g. */
|
||
|
||
for (insn = f, i = 0; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) != NOTE
|
||
|| NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) < 0)
|
||
INSN_CUID (insn) = ++i;
|
||
else
|
||
/* Give a line number note the same cuid as preceding insn. */
|
||
INSN_CUID (insn) = i;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize which registers are clobbered by calls. */
|
||
|
||
CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (regs_invalidated_by_call);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
|
||
if ((call_used_regs[i]
|
||
/* Used to check !fixed_regs[i] here, but that isn't safe;
|
||
fixed regs are still call-clobbered, and sched can get
|
||
confused if they can "live across calls".
|
||
|
||
The frame pointer is always preserved across calls. The arg
|
||
pointer is if it is fixed. The stack pointer usually is, unless
|
||
RETURN_POPS_ARGS, in which case an explicit CLOBBER
|
||
will be present. If we are generating PIC code, the PIC offset
|
||
table register is preserved across calls. */
|
||
|
||
&& i != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& i != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& i != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
#endif
|
||
#if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& ! (i == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && fixed_regs[i])
|
||
#endif
|
||
#if defined (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM) && !defined (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED)
|
||
&& ! (i == PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM && flag_pic)
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
|| global_regs[i])
|
||
SET_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, i);
|
||
|
||
/* Loop over basic blocks.
|
||
Compute the maximum number of qty's needed for each basic block
|
||
(which is 2 for each SET). */
|
||
insn = f;
|
||
while (insn)
|
||
{
|
||
cse_end_of_basic_block (insn, &val, flag_cse_follow_jumps, after_loop,
|
||
flag_cse_skip_blocks);
|
||
|
||
/* If this basic block was already processed or has no sets, skip it. */
|
||
if (val.nsets == 0 || GET_MODE (insn) == QImode)
|
||
{
|
||
PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
|
||
insn = (val.last ? NEXT_INSN (val.last) : 0);
|
||
val.path_size = 0;
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
cse_basic_block_start = val.low_cuid;
|
||
cse_basic_block_end = val.high_cuid;
|
||
max_qty = val.nsets * 2;
|
||
|
||
if (file)
|
||
fprintf (file, ";; Processing block from %d to %d, %d sets.\n",
|
||
INSN_UID (insn), val.last ? INSN_UID (val.last) : 0,
|
||
val.nsets);
|
||
|
||
/* Make MAX_QTY bigger to give us room to optimize
|
||
past the end of this basic block, if that should prove useful. */
|
||
if (max_qty < 500)
|
||
max_qty = 500;
|
||
|
||
max_qty += max_reg;
|
||
|
||
/* If this basic block is being extended by following certain jumps,
|
||
(see `cse_end_of_basic_block'), we reprocess the code from the start.
|
||
Otherwise, we start after this basic block. */
|
||
if (val.path_size > 0)
|
||
cse_basic_block (insn, val.last, val.path, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
int old_cse_jumps_altered = cse_jumps_altered;
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
/* When cse changes a conditional jump to an unconditional
|
||
jump, we want to reprocess the block, since it will give
|
||
us a new branch path to investigate. */
|
||
cse_jumps_altered = 0;
|
||
temp = cse_basic_block (insn, val.last, val.path, ! after_loop);
|
||
if (cse_jumps_altered == 0
|
||
|| (flag_cse_follow_jumps == 0 && flag_cse_skip_blocks == 0))
|
||
insn = temp;
|
||
|
||
cse_jumps_altered |= old_cse_jumps_altered;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef USE_C_ALLOCA
|
||
alloca (0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Tell refers_to_mem_p that qty_const info is not available. */
|
||
qty_const = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (max_elements_made < n_elements_made)
|
||
max_elements_made = n_elements_made;
|
||
|
||
return cse_jumps_altered;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Process a single basic block. FROM and TO and the limits of the basic
|
||
block. NEXT_BRANCH points to the branch path when following jumps or
|
||
a null path when not following jumps.
|
||
|
||
AROUND_LOOP is non-zero if we are to try to cse around to the start of a
|
||
loop. This is true when we are being called for the last time on a
|
||
block and this CSE pass is before loop.c. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
cse_basic_block (from, to, next_branch, around_loop)
|
||
register rtx from, to;
|
||
struct branch_path *next_branch;
|
||
int around_loop;
|
||
{
|
||
register rtx insn;
|
||
int to_usage = 0;
|
||
int in_libcall_block = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Each of these arrays is undefined before max_reg, so only allocate
|
||
the space actually needed and adjust the start below. */
|
||
|
||
qty_first_reg = (int *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (int));
|
||
qty_last_reg = (int *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (int));
|
||
qty_mode= (enum machine_mode *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (enum machine_mode));
|
||
qty_const = (rtx *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (rtx));
|
||
qty_const_insn = (rtx *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (rtx));
|
||
qty_comparison_code
|
||
= (enum rtx_code *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (enum rtx_code));
|
||
qty_comparison_qty = (int *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (int));
|
||
qty_comparison_const = (rtx *) alloca ((max_qty - max_reg) * sizeof (rtx));
|
||
|
||
qty_first_reg -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_last_reg -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_mode -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_const -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_const_insn -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_comparison_code -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_comparison_qty -= max_reg;
|
||
qty_comparison_const -= max_reg;
|
||
|
||
new_basic_block ();
|
||
|
||
/* TO might be a label. If so, protect it from being deleted. */
|
||
if (to != 0 && GET_CODE (to) == CODE_LABEL)
|
||
++LABEL_NUSES (to);
|
||
|
||
for (insn = from; insn != to; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
register enum rtx_code code;
|
||
|
||
/* See if this is a branch that is part of the path. If so, and it is
|
||
to be taken, do so. */
|
||
if (next_branch->branch == insn)
|
||
{
|
||
enum taken status = next_branch++->status;
|
||
if (status != NOT_TAKEN)
|
||
{
|
||
if (status == TAKEN)
|
||
record_jump_equiv (insn, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
invalidate_skipped_block (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
||
|
||
/* Set the last insn as the jump insn; it doesn't affect cc0.
|
||
Then follow this branch. */
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
prev_insn_cc0 = 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
prev_insn = insn;
|
||
insn = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
code = GET_CODE (insn);
|
||
if (GET_MODE (insn) == QImode)
|
||
PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'i')
|
||
{
|
||
/* Process notes first so we have all notes in canonical forms when
|
||
looking for duplicate operations. */
|
||
|
||
if (REG_NOTES (insn))
|
||
REG_NOTES (insn) = cse_process_notes (REG_NOTES (insn), NULL_RTX);
|
||
|
||
/* Track when we are inside in LIBCALL block. Inside such a block,
|
||
we do not want to record destinations. The last insn of a
|
||
LIBCALL block is not considered to be part of the block, since
|
||
its destination is the result of the block and hence should be
|
||
recorded. */
|
||
|
||
if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX))
|
||
in_libcall_block = 1;
|
||
else if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX))
|
||
in_libcall_block = 0;
|
||
|
||
cse_insn (insn, in_libcall_block);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If INSN is now an unconditional jump, skip to the end of our
|
||
basic block by pretending that we just did the last insn in the
|
||
basic block. If we are jumping to the end of our block, show
|
||
that we can have one usage of TO. */
|
||
|
||
if (simplejump_p (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (to == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (JUMP_LABEL (insn) == to)
|
||
to_usage = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Maybe TO was deleted because the jump is unconditional.
|
||
If so, there is nothing left in this basic block. */
|
||
/* ??? Perhaps it would be smarter to set TO
|
||
to whatever follows this insn,
|
||
and pretend the basic block had always ended here. */
|
||
if (INSN_DELETED_P (to))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
insn = PREV_INSN (to);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* See if it is ok to keep on going past the label
|
||
which used to end our basic block. Remember that we incremented
|
||
the count of that label, so we decrement it here. If we made
|
||
a jump unconditional, TO_USAGE will be one; in that case, we don't
|
||
want to count the use in that jump. */
|
||
|
||
if (to != 0 && NEXT_INSN (insn) == to
|
||
&& GET_CODE (to) == CODE_LABEL && --LABEL_NUSES (to) == to_usage)
|
||
{
|
||
struct cse_basic_block_data val;
|
||
|
||
insn = NEXT_INSN (to);
|
||
|
||
if (LABEL_NUSES (to) == 0)
|
||
delete_insn (to);
|
||
|
||
/* Find the end of the following block. Note that we won't be
|
||
following branches in this case. If TO was the last insn
|
||
in the function, we are done. Similarly, if we deleted the
|
||
insn after TO, it must have been because it was preceded by
|
||
a BARRIER. In that case, we are done with this block because it
|
||
has no continuation. */
|
||
|
||
if (insn == 0 || INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
to_usage = 0;
|
||
val.path_size = 0;
|
||
cse_end_of_basic_block (insn, &val, 0, 0, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* If the tables we allocated have enough space left
|
||
to handle all the SETs in the next basic block,
|
||
continue through it. Otherwise, return,
|
||
and that block will be scanned individually. */
|
||
if (val.nsets * 2 + next_qty > max_qty)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
cse_basic_block_start = val.low_cuid;
|
||
cse_basic_block_end = val.high_cuid;
|
||
to = val.last;
|
||
|
||
/* Prevent TO from being deleted if it is a label. */
|
||
if (to != 0 && GET_CODE (to) == CODE_LABEL)
|
||
++LABEL_NUSES (to);
|
||
|
||
/* Back up so we process the first insn in the extension. */
|
||
insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (next_qty > max_qty)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* If we are running before loop.c, we stopped on a NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END, and
|
||
the previous insn is the only insn that branches to the head of a loop,
|
||
we can cse into the loop. Don't do this if we changed the jump
|
||
structure of a loop unless we aren't going to be following jumps. */
|
||
|
||
if ((cse_jumps_altered == 0
|
||
|| (flag_cse_follow_jumps == 0 && flag_cse_skip_blocks == 0))
|
||
&& around_loop && to != 0
|
||
&& GET_CODE (to) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (to) == NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PREV_INSN (to)) == JUMP_INSN
|
||
&& JUMP_LABEL (PREV_INSN (to)) != 0
|
||
&& LABEL_NUSES (JUMP_LABEL (PREV_INSN (to))) == 1)
|
||
cse_around_loop (JUMP_LABEL (PREV_INSN (to)));
|
||
|
||
return to ? NEXT_INSN (to) : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Count the number of times registers are used (not set) in X.
|
||
COUNTS is an array in which we accumulate the count, INCR is how much
|
||
we count each register usage.
|
||
|
||
Don't count a usage of DEST, which is the SET_DEST of a SET which
|
||
contains X in its SET_SRC. This is because such a SET does not
|
||
modify the liveness of DEST. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
count_reg_usage (x, counts, dest, incr)
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
int *counts;
|
||
rtx dest;
|
||
int incr;
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
char *fmt;
|
||
int i, j;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (code = GET_CODE (x))
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
if (x != dest)
|
||
counts[REGNO (x)] += incr;
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case PC:
|
||
case CC0:
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case CLOBBER:
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case SET:
|
||
/* Unless we are setting a REG, count everything in SET_DEST. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) != REG)
|
||
count_reg_usage (SET_DEST (x), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
|
||
/* If SRC has side-effects, then we can't delete this insn, so the
|
||
usage of SET_DEST inside SRC counts.
|
||
|
||
??? Strictly-speaking, we might be preserving this insn
|
||
because some other SET has side-effects, but that's hard
|
||
to do and can't happen now. */
|
||
count_reg_usage (SET_SRC (x), counts,
|
||
side_effects_p (SET_SRC (x)) ? NULL_RTX : SET_DEST (x),
|
||
incr);
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case CALL_INSN:
|
||
count_reg_usage (CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (x), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
|
||
/* ... falls through ... */
|
||
case INSN:
|
||
case JUMP_INSN:
|
||
count_reg_usage (PATTERN (x), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
|
||
/* Things used in a REG_EQUAL note aren't dead since loop may try to
|
||
use them. */
|
||
|
||
count_reg_usage (REG_NOTES (x), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case EXPR_LIST:
|
||
case INSN_LIST:
|
||
if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_EQUAL
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (x,0)) == USE)
|
||
count_reg_usage (XEXP (x, 0), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
count_reg_usage (XEXP (x, 1), counts, NULL_RTX, incr);
|
||
return;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
||
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
||
count_reg_usage (XEXP (x, i), counts, dest, incr);
|
||
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
||
for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
|
||
count_reg_usage (XVECEXP (x, i, j), counts, dest, incr);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Scan all the insns and delete any that are dead; i.e., they store a register
|
||
that is never used or they copy a register to itself.
|
||
|
||
This is used to remove insns made obviously dead by cse. It improves the
|
||
heuristics in loop since it won't try to move dead invariants out of loops
|
||
or make givs for dead quantities. The remaining passes of the compilation
|
||
are also sped up. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
delete_dead_from_cse (insns, nreg)
|
||
rtx insns;
|
||
int nreg;
|
||
{
|
||
int *counts = (int *) alloca (nreg * sizeof (int));
|
||
rtx insn, prev;
|
||
rtx tem;
|
||
int i;
|
||
int in_libcall = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* First count the number of times each register is used. */
|
||
bzero ((char *) counts, sizeof (int) * nreg);
|
||
for (insn = next_real_insn (insns); insn; insn = next_real_insn (insn))
|
||
count_reg_usage (insn, counts, NULL_RTX, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Go from the last insn to the first and delete insns that only set unused
|
||
registers or copy a register to itself. As we delete an insn, remove
|
||
usage counts for registers it uses. */
|
||
for (insn = prev_real_insn (get_last_insn ()); insn; insn = prev)
|
||
{
|
||
int live_insn = 0;
|
||
|
||
prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't delete any insns that are part of a libcall block.
|
||
Flow or loop might get confused if we did that. Remember
|
||
that we are scanning backwards. */
|
||
if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX))
|
||
in_libcall = 1;
|
||
|
||
if (in_libcall)
|
||
live_insn = 1;
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn))) == REG
|
||
&& SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)) == SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn))) == CC0
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
|
||
&& ((tem = next_nonnote_insn (insn)) == 0
|
||
|| GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (tem)) != 'i'
|
||
|| ! reg_referenced_p (cc0_rtx, PATTERN (tem))))
|
||
;
|
||
#endif
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn))) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
|| counts[REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))] != 0
|
||
|| side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn))))
|
||
live_insn = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL)
|
||
for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx elt = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (elt) == SET)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (elt)) == REG
|
||
&& SET_DEST (elt) == SET_SRC (elt))
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (elt)) == CC0
|
||
&& ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (elt))
|
||
&& ((tem = next_nonnote_insn (insn)) == 0
|
||
|| GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (tem)) != 'i'
|
||
|| ! reg_referenced_p (cc0_rtx, PATTERN (tem))))
|
||
;
|
||
#endif
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (elt)) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (SET_DEST (elt)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
|| counts[REGNO (SET_DEST (elt))] != 0
|
||
|| side_effects_p (SET_SRC (elt)))
|
||
live_insn = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (elt) != CLOBBER && GET_CODE (elt) != USE)
|
||
live_insn = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
live_insn = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a dead insn, delete it and show registers in it aren't
|
||
being used. */
|
||
|
||
if (! live_insn)
|
||
{
|
||
count_reg_usage (insn, counts, NULL_RTX, -1);
|
||
delete_insn (insn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX))
|
||
in_libcall = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|